xref: /linux/include/net/cfg80211.h (revision 4cde72fead4cebb5b6b2fe9425904c2064739184)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2021, 2023 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27 
28 /**
29  * DOC: Introduction
30  *
31  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37  *
38  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39  * use restrictions.
40  */
41 
42 
43 /**
44  * DOC: Device registration
45  *
46  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48  * described below.
49  *
50  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55  * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
56  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59  *
60  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63  */
64 
65 struct wiphy;
66 
67 /*
68  * wireless hardware capability structures
69  */
70 
71 /**
72  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73  *
74  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75  *
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
80  *	channel.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
83  *	is not permitted.
84  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
85  *	is not permitted.
86  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
88  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
89  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91  *	restrictions.
92  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
93  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
94  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
95  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
96  *	restrictions.
97  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
102  *	on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
104  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105  *	on this channel.
106  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107  *	on this channel.
108  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109  *	on this channel.
110  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111  *	on this channel.
112  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
113  *	on this channel.
114  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
115  *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
116  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
117  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
118  *	restrictions.
119  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
120  */
121 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
122 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
123 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
124 	IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD		= 1<<2,
125 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
126 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
127 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
128 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
129 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
131 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
132 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
133 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
134 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
135 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
136 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
137 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
138 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
139 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
140 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
141 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ	= 1<<19,
142 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT		= 1<<20,
143 };
144 
145 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
146 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
147 
148 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
149 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
150 
151 /**
152  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
153  *
154  * This structure describes a single channel for use
155  * with cfg80211.
156  *
157  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
158  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
159  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
160  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
161  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
162  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
163  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
164  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
165  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
166  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
167  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
168  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
169  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
170  * @orig_mag: internal use
171  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
172  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
173  *	on this channel.
174  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
175  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
176  * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
177  */
178 struct ieee80211_channel {
179 	enum nl80211_band band;
180 	u32 center_freq;
181 	u16 freq_offset;
182 	u16 hw_value;
183 	u32 flags;
184 	int max_antenna_gain;
185 	int max_power;
186 	int max_reg_power;
187 	bool beacon_found;
188 	u32 orig_flags;
189 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
190 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
191 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
192 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
193 	s8 psd;
194 };
195 
196 /**
197  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
198  *
199  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
200  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
201  * different bands/PHY modes.
202  *
203  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
204  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
205  *	with CCK rates.
206  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
207  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
208  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
209  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
210  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
211  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
212  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
213  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
214  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
215  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
216  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
217  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
218  */
219 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
220 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
221 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
222 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
223 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
224 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
225 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
226 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
227 };
228 
229 /**
230  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
231  *
232  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
233  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
234  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
235  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
236  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
237  */
238 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
239 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
240 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
241 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
242 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
243 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
244 };
245 
246 /**
247  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
248  *
249  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
250  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
251  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
252  */
253 enum ieee80211_privacy {
254 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
255 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
256 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
257 };
258 
259 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
260 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
261 
262 /**
263  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
264  *
265  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
266  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
267  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
268  * passed around.
269  *
270  * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
271  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
272  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
273  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
274  *	short preamble is used
275  */
276 struct ieee80211_rate {
277 	u32 flags;
278 	u16 bitrate;
279 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
280 };
281 
282 /**
283  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
284  *
285  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
286  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
287  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
288  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
289  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
290  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
291  *	members of the SRG
292  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
293  *	used by members of the SRG
294  */
295 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
296 	bool enable;
297 	u8 sr_ctrl;
298 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
299 	u8 min_offset;
300 	u8 max_offset;
301 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
302 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
303 };
304 
305 /**
306  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
307  *
308  * @color: the current color.
309  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
310  * @partial: define the AID equation.
311  */
312 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
313 	u8 color;
314 	bool enabled;
315 	bool partial;
316 };
317 
318 /**
319  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
320  *
321  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
322  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
323  *
324  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
325  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
326  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
327  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
328  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
329  */
330 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
331 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
332 	bool ht_supported;
333 	u8 ampdu_factor;
334 	u8 ampdu_density;
335 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
336 };
337 
338 /**
339  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
340  *
341  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
342  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
343  *
344  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
345  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
346  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
347  */
348 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
349 	bool vht_supported;
350 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
351 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
352 };
353 
354 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
355 
356 /**
357  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
358  *
359  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
360  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
361  *
362  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
363  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
364  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
365  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
366  */
367 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
368 	bool has_he;
369 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
370 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
371 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
372 };
373 
374 /**
375  * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
376  *
377  * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
378  * and NSS Set field"
379  *
380  * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
381  * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
382  * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
383  * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
384  * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
385  */
386 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
387 	union {
388 		struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
389 		struct {
390 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
391 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
392 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
393 		} __packed bw;
394 	} __packed;
395 } __packed;
396 
397 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32
398 
399 /**
400  * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
401  *
402  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
403  * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
404  *
405  * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
406  * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
407  * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
408  * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
409  */
410 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
411 	bool has_eht;
412 	struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
413 	struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
414 	u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
415 };
416 
417 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
418 #ifdef __CHECKER__
419 /*
420  * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
421  * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
422  * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
423  * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
424  */
425 # define __iftd		__attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
426 #else
427 # define __iftd
428 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
429 
430 /**
431  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
432  *
433  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
434  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
435  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
436  *
437  * @types_mask: interface types mask
438  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
439  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
440  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
441  * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
442  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
443  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
444  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
445  */
446 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
447 	u16 types_mask;
448 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
449 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
450 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
451 	struct {
452 		const u8 *data;
453 		unsigned int len;
454 	} vendor_elems;
455 };
456 
457 /**
458  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
459  *
460  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
461  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
462  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
463  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
464  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
465  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
466  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
467  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
468  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
469  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
470  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
471  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
472  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
473  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
474  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
475  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
476  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
477  */
478 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
479 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
480 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
481 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
482 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
483 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
484 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
485 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
486 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
487 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
488 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
489 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
490 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
491 };
492 
493 /**
494  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
495  *
496  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
497  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
498  *
499  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
500  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
501  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
502  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
503  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
504  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
505  */
506 struct ieee80211_edmg {
507 	u8 channels;
508 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
509 };
510 
511 /**
512  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
513  *
514  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
515  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
516  *
517  * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
518  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
519  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
520  */
521 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
522 	bool s1g;
523 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
524 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
525 };
526 
527 /**
528  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
529  *
530  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
531  * is able to operate in.
532  *
533  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
534  *	in this band.
535  * @band: the band this structure represents
536  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
537  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
538  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
539  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
540  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
541  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
542  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
543  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
544  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
545  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
546  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
547  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
548  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
549  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
550  *	iftype_data).
551  */
552 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
553 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
554 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
555 	enum nl80211_band band;
556 	int n_channels;
557 	int n_bitrates;
558 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
559 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
560 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
561 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
562 	u16 n_iftype_data;
563 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
564 };
565 
566 /**
567  * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
568  * @sband: the sband to initialize
569  * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
570  * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
571  *
572  * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
573  * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
574  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
575  */
576 static inline void
577 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
578 				 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
579 				 u16 n_iftd)
580 {
581 	sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
582 	sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
583 }
584 
585 /**
586  * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
587  * @sband: the sband to initialize
588  * @iftd: the iftype data array
589  */
590 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd)	\
591 	_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
592 
593 /**
594  * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
595  * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
596  * @i: iterator counter
597  * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
598  */
599 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd)				\
600 	for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i];	\
601 	     i < (sband)->n_iftype_data;					\
602 	     i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
603 
604 /**
605  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
606  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
607  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
608  *
609  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
610  */
611 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
612 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
613 				u8 iftype)
614 {
615 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
616 	int i;
617 
618 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
619 		return NULL;
620 
621 	if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
622 		iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
623 
624 	for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
625 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
626 			return data;
627 	}
628 
629 	return NULL;
630 }
631 
632 /**
633  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
634  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
635  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
636  *
637  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
638  */
639 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
640 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
641 			    u8 iftype)
642 {
643 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
644 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
645 
646 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
647 		return &data->he_cap;
648 
649 	return NULL;
650 }
651 
652 /**
653  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
654  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
655  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
656  *
657  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
658  */
659 static inline __le16
660 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
661 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
662 {
663 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
664 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
665 
666 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
667 		return 0;
668 
669 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
670 }
671 
672 /**
673  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
674  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
675  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
676  *
677  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
678  */
679 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
680 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
681 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
682 {
683 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
684 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
685 
686 	if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
687 		return &data->eht_cap;
688 
689 	return NULL;
690 }
691 
692 /**
693  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
694  *
695  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
696  *
697  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
698  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
699  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
700  *
701  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
702  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
703  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
704  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
705  * without affecting other devices.
706  *
707  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
708  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
709  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
710  */
711 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
712 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
713 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
714 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
715 {
716 }
717 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
718 
719 
720 /*
721  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
722  */
723 
724 /**
725  * DOC: Actions and configuration
726  *
727  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
728  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
729  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
730  * operations use are described separately.
731  *
732  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
733  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
734  *
735  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
736  * in a separate chapter.
737  */
738 
739 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
740 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
741 
742 /**
743  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
744  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
745  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
746  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
747  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
748  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
749  *	determine the address as needed.
750  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
751  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
752  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
753  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
754  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
755  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
756  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
757  */
758 struct vif_params {
759 	u32 flags;
760 	int use_4addr;
761 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
762 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
763 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
764 };
765 
766 /**
767  * struct key_params - key information
768  *
769  * Information about a key
770  *
771  * @key: key material
772  * @key_len: length of key material
773  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
774  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
775  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
776  *	length given by @seq_len.
777  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
778  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
779  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
780  */
781 struct key_params {
782 	const u8 *key;
783 	const u8 *seq;
784 	int key_len;
785 	int seq_len;
786 	u16 vlan_id;
787 	u32 cipher;
788 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
789 };
790 
791 /**
792  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
793  * @chan: the (control) channel
794  * @width: channel width
795  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
796  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
797  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
798  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
799  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
800  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
801  *	parameters are ignored.
802  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
803  */
804 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
805 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
806 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
807 	u32 center_freq1;
808 	u32 center_freq2;
809 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
810 	u16 freq1_offset;
811 };
812 
813 /*
814  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
815  */
816 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
817 	struct {
818 		u32 legacy;
819 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
820 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
821 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
822 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
823 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
824 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
825 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
826 };
827 
828 
829 /**
830  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
831  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
832  *	of the peer.
833  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
834  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
835  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
836  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
837  * @retry_long: retry count value
838  * @retry_short: retry count value
839  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
840  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
841  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
842  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
843  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
844  */
845 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
846 	bool config_override;
847 	u8 tids;
848 	u64 mask;
849 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
850 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
851 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
852 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
853 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
854 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
855 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
856 };
857 
858 /**
859  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
860  * @peer: Station's MAC address
861  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
862  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
863  */
864 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
865 	const u8 *peer;
866 	u32 n_tid_conf;
867 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
868 };
869 
870 /**
871  * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
872  * @macaddr: STA MAC address
873  * @kek: FILS KEK
874  * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
875  * @snonce: STA Nonce
876  * @anonce: AP Nonce
877  */
878 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
879 	const u8 *macaddr;
880 	const u8 *kek;
881 	u8 kek_len;
882 	const u8 *snonce;
883 	const u8 *anonce;
884 };
885 
886 /**
887  * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
888  * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
889  *	addresses.
890  * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
891  *	Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
892  */
893 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
894 	const u8 *macaddr;
895 	bool enable;
896 };
897 
898 /**
899  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
900  * @chandef: the channel definition
901  *
902  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
903  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
904  */
905 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
906 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
907 {
908 	switch (chandef->width) {
909 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
910 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
911 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
912 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
913 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
914 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
915 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
916 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
917 	default:
918 		WARN_ON(1);
919 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
920 	}
921 }
922 
923 /**
924  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
925  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
926  * @channel: the control channel
927  * @chantype: the channel type
928  *
929  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
930  */
931 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
932 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
933 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
934 
935 /**
936  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
937  * @chandef1: first channel definition
938  * @chandef2: second channel definition
939  *
940  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
941  * identical, %false otherwise.
942  */
943 static inline bool
944 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
945 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
946 {
947 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
948 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
949 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
950 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
951 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
952 }
953 
954 /**
955  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
956  *
957  * @chandef: the channel definition
958  *
959  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
960  */
961 static inline bool
962 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
963 {
964 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
965 }
966 
967 /**
968  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
969  * @chandef1: first channel definition
970  * @chandef2: second channel definition
971  *
972  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
973  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
974  */
975 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
976 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
977 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
978 
979 /**
980  * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
981  * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
982  *
983  * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
984  * is valid. -1 otherwise.
985  */
986 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
987 
988 /**
989  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
990  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
991  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
992  */
993 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
994 
995 /**
996  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
997  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
998  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
999  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1000  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1001  */
1002 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1003 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1004 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
1005 
1006 /**
1007  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1008  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1009  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1010  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1011  * Returns:
1012  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1013  */
1014 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1015 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1016 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1017 
1018 /**
1019  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1020  *				 can/need start CAC on such channel
1021  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1022  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1023  *
1024  * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1025  *	   one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1026  */
1027 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1028 				 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1029 
1030 /**
1031  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1032  *				   channel definition
1033  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1034  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1035  *
1036  * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1037  */
1038 unsigned int
1039 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1040 			      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1041 
1042 /**
1043  * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1044  * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1045  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1046  *
1047  * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1048  **/
1049 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1050 
1051 /**
1052  * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1053  * @width: the channel width of the channel
1054  *
1055  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1056  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1057  *
1058  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1059  */
1060 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
1061 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1062 {
1063 	switch (width) {
1064 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1065 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1066 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1067 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1068 	default:
1069 		break;
1070 	}
1071 	return 0;
1072 }
1073 
1074 /**
1075  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1076  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1077  *
1078  * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1079  *
1080  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1081  */
1082 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
1083 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1084 {
1085 	return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1086 }
1087 
1088 /**
1089  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1090  *
1091  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1092  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1093  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1094  *
1095  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1096  *
1097  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1098  */
1099 static inline int
1100 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1101 {
1102 	switch (chandef->width) {
1103 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1104 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1105 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1106 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1107 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1108 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1109 	default:
1110 		break;
1111 	}
1112 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
1113 }
1114 
1115 /**
1116  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1117  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1118  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1119  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1120  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1121  */
1122 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1123 				  unsigned long band_mask,
1124 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
1125 
1126 /**
1127  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1128  *
1129  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1130  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1131  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1132  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1133  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1134  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1135  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1136  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1137  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1138  *
1139  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1140  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1141  */
1142 enum survey_info_flags {
1143 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
1144 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
1145 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
1146 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
1147 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
1148 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
1149 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
1150 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
1151 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
1152 };
1153 
1154 /**
1155  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1156  *
1157  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1158  *	record to report global statistics
1159  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1160  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1161  *	optional
1162  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1163  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1164  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1165  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1166  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1167  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1168  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1169  *
1170  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1171  *
1172  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1173  * channel duty cycle etc.
1174  */
1175 struct survey_info {
1176 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1177 	u64 time;
1178 	u64 time_busy;
1179 	u64 time_ext_busy;
1180 	u64 time_rx;
1181 	u64 time_tx;
1182 	u64 time_scan;
1183 	u64 time_bss_rx;
1184 	u32 filled;
1185 	s8 noise;
1186 };
1187 
1188 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10
1189 
1190 /**
1191  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1192  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1193  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1194  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1195  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1196  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1197  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1198  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1199  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1200  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1201  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1202  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1203  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1204  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1205  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1206  *	protocol frames.
1207  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1208  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1209  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1210  *	port for mac80211
1211  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1212  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1213  *	offload)
1214  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1215  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1216  *
1217  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1218  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1219  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1220  *	  such a scenario.
1221  *
1222  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1223  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1224  *
1225  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1226  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1227  *
1228  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1229  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1230  */
1231 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1232 	u32 wpa_versions;
1233 	u32 cipher_group;
1234 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1235 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1236 	int n_akm_suites;
1237 	u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1238 	bool control_port;
1239 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1240 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1241 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1242 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1243 	const u8 *psk;
1244 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1245 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1246 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1247 };
1248 
1249 /**
1250  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1251  *
1252  * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1253  * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1254  * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1255  */
1256 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1257 	struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1258 	u8 index;
1259 	bool ema;
1260 };
1261 
1262 /**
1263  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1264  *
1265  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1266  *
1267  * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1268  * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1269  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1270  */
1271 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1272 	u8 cnt;
1273 	struct {
1274 		const u8 *data;
1275 		size_t len;
1276 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1277 };
1278 
1279 /**
1280  * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1281  *
1282  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1283  *
1284  * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1285  * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1286  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1287  */
1288 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1289 	u8 cnt;
1290 	struct {
1291 		const u8 *data;
1292 		size_t len;
1293 	} elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1294 };
1295 
1296 /**
1297  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1298  * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1299  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1300  *	or %NULL if not changed
1301  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1302  *	or %NULL if not changed
1303  * @head_len: length of @head
1304  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1305  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1306  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1307  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1308  *	frames or %NULL
1309  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1310  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1311  *	Response frames or %NULL
1312  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1313  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1314  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1315  * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1316  * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1317  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1318  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1319  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1320  *	(measurement type 8)
1321  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1322  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1323  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1324  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1325  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1326  * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1327  *	attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1328  */
1329 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1330 	unsigned int link_id;
1331 
1332 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1333 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1334 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1335 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1336 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1337 	const u8 *lci;
1338 	const u8 *civicloc;
1339 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1340 	struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1341 	s8 ftm_responder;
1342 
1343 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1344 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1345 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1346 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1347 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1348 	size_t lci_len;
1349 	size_t civicloc_len;
1350 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1351 	bool he_bss_color_valid;
1352 };
1353 
1354 struct mac_address {
1355 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1356 };
1357 
1358 /**
1359  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1360  *
1361  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1362  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1363  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1364  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1365  */
1366 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1367 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1368 	int n_acl_entries;
1369 
1370 	/* Keep it last */
1371 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1372 };
1373 
1374 /**
1375  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1376  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1377  *
1378  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1379  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1380  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1381  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1382  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1383  *	frame headers.
1384  */
1385 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1386 	bool update;
1387 	u32 min_interval;
1388 	u32 max_interval;
1389 	size_t tmpl_len;
1390 	const u8 *tmpl;
1391 };
1392 
1393 /**
1394  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1395  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1396  *
1397  * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1398  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1399  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1400  *	scanning
1401  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1402  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1403  */
1404 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1405 	bool update;
1406 	u32 interval;
1407 	size_t tmpl_len;
1408 	const u8 *tmpl;
1409 };
1410 
1411 /**
1412  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1413  *
1414  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1415  *
1416  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1417  * @beacon: beacon data
1418  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1419  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1420  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1421  *	user space)
1422  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1423  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1424  * @crypto: crypto settings
1425  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1426  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1427  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1428  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1429  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1430  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1431  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1432  *	MAC address based access control
1433  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1434  *	networks.
1435  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1436  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1437  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1438  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1439  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1440  * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1441  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1442  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1443  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1444  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1445  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1446  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1447  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1448  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1449  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1450  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1451  * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1452  * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1453  *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1454  *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1455  */
1456 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1457 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1458 
1459 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1460 
1461 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1462 	const u8 *ssid;
1463 	size_t ssid_len;
1464 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1465 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1466 	bool privacy;
1467 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1468 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1469 	int inactivity_timeout;
1470 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1471 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1472 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1473 	bool pbss;
1474 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1475 
1476 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1477 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1478 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1479 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1480 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1481 	const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1482 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1483 	bool twt_responder;
1484 	u32 flags;
1485 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1486 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1487 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1488 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1489 	u16 punct_bitmap;
1490 };
1491 
1492 
1493 /**
1494  * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1495  *
1496  * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1497  *
1498  * @beacon: beacon data
1499  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1500  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1501  */
1502 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1503 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1504 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1505 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1506 };
1507 
1508 /**
1509  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1510  *
1511  * Used for channel switch
1512  *
1513  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1514  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1515  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1516  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1517  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1518  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1519  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1520  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1521  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1522  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1523  * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1524  *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1525  *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1526  */
1527 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1528 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1529 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1530 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1531 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1532 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1533 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1534 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1535 	bool radar_required;
1536 	bool block_tx;
1537 	u8 count;
1538 	u16 punct_bitmap;
1539 };
1540 
1541 /**
1542  * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1543  *
1544  * Used for bss color change
1545  *
1546  * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1547  * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1548  * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1549  * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1550  * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1551  * @color: the color used after the change
1552  */
1553 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1554 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1555 	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1556 	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1557 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1558 	u8 count;
1559 	u8 color;
1560 };
1561 
1562 /**
1563  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1564  *
1565  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1566  *
1567  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1568  *	to use for verification
1569  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1570  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1571  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1572  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1573  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1574  *	nl80211_iftype.
1575  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1576  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1577  *	the verification
1578  */
1579 struct iface_combination_params {
1580 	int num_different_channels;
1581 	u8 radar_detect;
1582 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1583 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1584 };
1585 
1586 /**
1587  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1588  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1589  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1590  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1591  *
1592  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1593  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1594  */
1595 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1596 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1597 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1598 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1599 };
1600 
1601 /**
1602  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1603  *
1604  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1605  *
1606  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1607  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1608  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1609  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1610  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1611  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1612  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1613  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1614  *	per peer TPC.
1615  */
1616 struct sta_txpwr {
1617 	s16 power;
1618 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1619 };
1620 
1621 /**
1622  * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1623  *
1624  * Used to change and create a new link station.
1625  *
1626  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1627  * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1628  * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1629  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1630  *	(or NULL for no change)
1631  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1632  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1633  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1634  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1635  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1636  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1637  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1638  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1639  * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1640  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1641  * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1642  * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1643  */
1644 struct link_station_parameters {
1645 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1646 	int link_id;
1647 	const u8 *link_mac;
1648 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1649 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1650 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1651 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1652 	u8 opmode_notif;
1653 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1654 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1655 	u8 he_capa_len;
1656 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1657 	bool txpwr_set;
1658 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1659 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1660 	u8 eht_capa_len;
1661 };
1662 
1663 /**
1664  * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1665  *
1666  * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1667  *
1668  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1669  * @link_id: the link id
1670  */
1671 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1672 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1673 	u32 link_id;
1674 };
1675 
1676 /**
1677  * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1678  *
1679  * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1680  *
1681  * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1682  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1683  * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1684  *     (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1685  */
1686 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1687 	u16 dlink[8];
1688 	u16 ulink[8];
1689 };
1690 
1691 /**
1692  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1693  *
1694  * Used to change and create a new station.
1695  *
1696  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1697  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1698  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1699  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1700  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1701  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1702  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1703  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1704  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1705  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1706  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1707  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1708  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1709  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1710  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1711  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1712  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1713  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1714  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1715  *	to unknown)
1716  * @capability: station capability
1717  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1718  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1719  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1720  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1721  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1722  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1723  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1724  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1725  * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1726  */
1727 struct station_parameters {
1728 	struct net_device *vlan;
1729 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1730 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1731 	int listen_interval;
1732 	u16 aid;
1733 	u16 vlan_id;
1734 	u16 peer_aid;
1735 	u8 plink_action;
1736 	u8 plink_state;
1737 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1738 	u8 max_sp;
1739 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1740 	u16 capability;
1741 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1742 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1743 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1744 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1745 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1746 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1747 	int support_p2p_ps;
1748 	u16 airtime_weight;
1749 	struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1750 };
1751 
1752 /**
1753  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1754  *
1755  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1756  *
1757  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1758  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1759  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1760  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1761  */
1762 struct station_del_parameters {
1763 	const u8 *mac;
1764 	u8 subtype;
1765 	u16 reason_code;
1766 };
1767 
1768 /**
1769  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1770  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1771  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1772  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1773  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1774  *	the AP MLME in the device
1775  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1776  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1777  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1778  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1779  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1780  *	supported/used)
1781  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1782  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1783  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1784  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1785  */
1786 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1787 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1788 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1789 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1790 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1791 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1792 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1793 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1794 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1795 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1796 };
1797 
1798 /**
1799  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1800  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1801  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1802  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1803  *
1804  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1805  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1806  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1807  * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1808  * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1809  */
1810 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1811 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1812 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1813 
1814 /**
1815  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1816  *
1817  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1818  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1819  *
1820  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1821  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1822  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1823  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1824  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1825  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1826  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1827  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1828  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1829  */
1830 enum rate_info_flags {
1831 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1832 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1833 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1834 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1835 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1836 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1837 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1838 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7),
1839 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS			= BIT(8),
1840 };
1841 
1842 /**
1843  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1844  *
1845  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1846  *
1847  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1848  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1849  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1850  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1851  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1852  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1853  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1854  * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1855  * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1856  * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1857  * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1858  * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1859  * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1860  * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1861  */
1862 enum rate_info_bw {
1863 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1864 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1865 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1866 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1867 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1868 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1869 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1870 	RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1871 	RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1872 	RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1873 	RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1874 	RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1875 	RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1876 	RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1877 };
1878 
1879 /**
1880  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1881  *
1882  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1883  *
1884  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1885  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1886  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1887  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1888  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1889  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1890  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1891  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1892  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1893  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1894  * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1895  * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1896  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1897  */
1898 struct rate_info {
1899 	u16 flags;
1900 	u16 legacy;
1901 	u8 mcs;
1902 	u8 nss;
1903 	u8 bw;
1904 	u8 he_gi;
1905 	u8 he_dcm;
1906 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1907 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1908 	u8 eht_gi;
1909 	u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1910 };
1911 
1912 /**
1913  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1914  *
1915  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1916  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1917  *
1918  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1919  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1920  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1921  */
1922 enum bss_param_flags {
1923 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1924 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1925 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1926 };
1927 
1928 /**
1929  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1930  *
1931  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1932  *
1933  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1934  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1935  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1936  */
1937 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1938 	u8 flags;
1939 	u8 dtim_period;
1940 	u16 beacon_interval;
1941 };
1942 
1943 /**
1944  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1945  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1946  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1947  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1948  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1949  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1950  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1951  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1952  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1953  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1954  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1955  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1956  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1957  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1958  */
1959 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1960 	u32 filled;
1961 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1962 	u32 backlog_packets;
1963 	u32 flows;
1964 	u32 drops;
1965 	u32 ecn_marks;
1966 	u32 overlimit;
1967 	u32 overmemory;
1968 	u32 collisions;
1969 	u32 tx_bytes;
1970 	u32 tx_packets;
1971 	u32 max_flows;
1972 };
1973 
1974 /**
1975  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1976  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1977  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1978  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1979  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1980  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1981  *	transmitted MSDUs
1982  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1983  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1984  */
1985 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1986 	u32 filled;
1987 	u64 rx_msdu;
1988 	u64 tx_msdu;
1989 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1990 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1991 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1992 };
1993 
1994 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1995 
1996 /**
1997  * struct station_info - station information
1998  *
1999  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2000  *
2001  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2002  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2003  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2004  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2005  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2006  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2007  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2008  * @llid: mesh local link id
2009  * @plid: mesh peer link id
2010  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2011  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2012  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2013  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2014  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2015  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2016  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2017  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2018  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2019  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2020  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2021  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2022  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2023  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2024  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
2025  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2026  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2027  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
2028  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2029  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2030  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2031  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2032  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2033  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2034  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2035  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2036  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2037  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2038  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2039  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2040  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2041  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2042  *	towards this station.
2043  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2044  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2045  *	from this peer
2046  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2047  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2048  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2049  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2050  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2051  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2052  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2053  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2054  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2055  *	been sent.
2056  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2057  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2058  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2059  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2060  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2061  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2062  * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2063  *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2064  *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2065  *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2066  *	dump_station() callbacks.
2067  * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2068  *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2069  *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2070  * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2071  *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2072  * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2073  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2074  *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2075  *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2076  *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2077  *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2078  *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2079  * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2080  */
2081 struct station_info {
2082 	u64 filled;
2083 	u32 connected_time;
2084 	u32 inactive_time;
2085 	u64 assoc_at;
2086 	u64 rx_bytes;
2087 	u64 tx_bytes;
2088 	u16 llid;
2089 	u16 plid;
2090 	u8 plink_state;
2091 	s8 signal;
2092 	s8 signal_avg;
2093 
2094 	u8 chains;
2095 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2096 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2097 
2098 	struct rate_info txrate;
2099 	struct rate_info rxrate;
2100 	u32 rx_packets;
2101 	u32 tx_packets;
2102 	u32 tx_retries;
2103 	u32 tx_failed;
2104 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2105 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2106 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2107 
2108 	int generation;
2109 
2110 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2111 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2112 
2113 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
2114 	s64 t_offset;
2115 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2116 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2117 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2118 
2119 	u32 expected_throughput;
2120 
2121 	u64 tx_duration;
2122 	u64 rx_duration;
2123 	u64 rx_beacon;
2124 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2125 	u8 connected_to_gate;
2126 
2127 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2128 	s8 ack_signal;
2129 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
2130 
2131 	u16 airtime_weight;
2132 
2133 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2134 	u32 fcs_err_count;
2135 
2136 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
2137 
2138 	u8 connected_to_as;
2139 
2140 	bool mlo_params_valid;
2141 	u8 assoc_link_id;
2142 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2143 	const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2144 	size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2145 };
2146 
2147 /**
2148  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2149  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2150  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2151  */
2152 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2153 	s32 power;
2154 	u32 freq_range_index;
2155 };
2156 
2157 /**
2158  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2159  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2160  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2161  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2162  */
2163 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2164 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2165 	u32 num_sub_specs;
2166 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
2167 };
2168 
2169 
2170 /**
2171  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2172  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
2173  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
2174  */
2175 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2176 	u32 start_freq;
2177 	u32 end_freq;
2178 };
2179 
2180 /**
2181  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2182  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2183  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2184  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2185  *
2186  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2187  * range to small ones and then append them.
2188  */
2189 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2190 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2191 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
2192 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2193 };
2194 
2195 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2196 /**
2197  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2198  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2199  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2200  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2201  *
2202  * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2203  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2204  * considered undefined.
2205  */
2206 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2207 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
2208 #else
2209 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2210 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
2211 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
2212 {
2213 	return -ENOENT;
2214 }
2215 #endif
2216 
2217 /**
2218  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2219  *
2220  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2221  * according to the nl80211 flags.
2222  *
2223  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2224  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2225  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2226  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2227  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2228  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2229  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2230  */
2231 enum monitor_flags {
2232 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
2233 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
2234 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
2235 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
2236 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
2237 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
2238 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
2239 };
2240 
2241 /**
2242  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
2243  *
2244  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2245  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2246  *
2247  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2248  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2249  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2250  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2251  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2252  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2253  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2254  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2255  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2256  */
2257 enum mpath_info_flags {
2258 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
2259 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
2260 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
2261 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
2262 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
2263 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
2264 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
2265 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
2266 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
2267 };
2268 
2269 /**
2270  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2271  *
2272  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2273  *
2274  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2275  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2276  * @sn: target sequence number
2277  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2278  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2279  * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2280  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2281  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2282  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2283  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2284  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2285  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2286  * @hop_count: hops to destination
2287  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2288  */
2289 struct mpath_info {
2290 	u32 filled;
2291 	u32 frame_qlen;
2292 	u32 sn;
2293 	u32 metric;
2294 	u32 exptime;
2295 	u32 discovery_timeout;
2296 	u8 discovery_retries;
2297 	u8 flags;
2298 	u8 hop_count;
2299 	u32 path_change_count;
2300 
2301 	int generation;
2302 };
2303 
2304 /**
2305  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2306  *
2307  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2308  *
2309  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2310  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2311  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2312  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2313  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2314  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2315  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2316  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2317  *	(or NULL for no change)
2318  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2319  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2320  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2321  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2322  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2323  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2324  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2325  */
2326 struct bss_parameters {
2327 	int link_id;
2328 	int use_cts_prot;
2329 	int use_short_preamble;
2330 	int use_short_slot_time;
2331 	const u8 *basic_rates;
2332 	u8 basic_rates_len;
2333 	int ap_isolate;
2334 	int ht_opmode;
2335 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2336 };
2337 
2338 /**
2339  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2340  *
2341  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2342  *
2343  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2344  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
2345  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2346  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2347  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2348  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2349  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2350  *	mesh interface
2351  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2352  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2353  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2354  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2355  *	elements
2356  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2357  *	detect compatible mesh peers
2358  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2359  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2360  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2361  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2362  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2363  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2364  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
2365  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2366  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2367  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2368  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2369  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2370  *	element
2371  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2372  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2373  *	element
2374  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2375  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2376  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2377  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2378  *	announcements are transmitted
2379  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2380  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2381  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2382  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2383  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2384  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2385  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2386  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2387  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2388  *	station to establish a peer link
2389  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2390  *
2391  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2392  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2393  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2394  *
2395  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2396  *	PREQs are transmitted.
2397  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2398  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2399  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2400  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2401  *	setting for new peer links.
2402  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2403  *	after transmitting its beacon.
2404  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2405  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2406  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2407  * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2408  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2409  *	in the mesh formation field.
2410  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2411  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2412  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2413  *      in the mesh path table
2414  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2415  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2416  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2417  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2418  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2419  */
2420 struct mesh_config {
2421 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2422 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2423 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2424 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2425 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2426 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2427 	u8 element_ttl;
2428 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2429 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2430 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2431 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2432 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2433 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2434 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2435 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2436 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2437 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2438 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2439 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2440 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2441 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2442 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2443 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2444 	u16 ht_opmode;
2445 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2446 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2447 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2448 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2449 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2450 	u32 plink_timeout;
2451 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2452 };
2453 
2454 /**
2455  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2456  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2457  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2458  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2459  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2460  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2461  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2462  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2463  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2464  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2465  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2466  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2467  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2468  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2469  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2470  * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2471  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2472  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2473  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2474  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2475  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2476  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2477  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2478  *
2479  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2480  */
2481 struct mesh_setup {
2482 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2483 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2484 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2485 	u8 sync_method;
2486 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2487 	u8 path_metric;
2488 	u8 auth_id;
2489 	const u8 *ie;
2490 	u8 ie_len;
2491 	bool is_authenticated;
2492 	bool is_secure;
2493 	bool user_mpm;
2494 	u8 dtim_period;
2495 	u16 beacon_interval;
2496 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2497 	u32 basic_rates;
2498 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2499 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2500 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2501 };
2502 
2503 /**
2504  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2505  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2506  *
2507  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2508  */
2509 struct ocb_setup {
2510 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2511 };
2512 
2513 /**
2514  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2515  * @ac: AC identifier
2516  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2517  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2518  *	1..32767]
2519  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2520  *	1..32767]
2521  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2522  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2523  */
2524 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2525 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2526 	u16 txop;
2527 	u16 cwmin;
2528 	u16 cwmax;
2529 	u8 aifs;
2530 	int link_id;
2531 };
2532 
2533 /**
2534  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2535  *
2536  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2537  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2538  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2539  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2540  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2541  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2542  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2543  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2544  * in the wiphy structure.
2545  *
2546  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2547  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2548  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2549  *
2550  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2551  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2552  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2553  * to userspace.
2554  */
2555 
2556 /**
2557  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2558  * @ssid: the SSID
2559  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2560  */
2561 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2562 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2563 	u8 ssid_len;
2564 };
2565 
2566 /**
2567  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2568  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2569  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2570  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2571  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2572  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2573  *	userspace will be notified of that
2574  */
2575 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2576 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2577 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2578 	bool aborted;
2579 };
2580 
2581 /**
2582  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2583  *
2584  * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2585  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2586  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2587  *	 which the above info is relevant to
2588  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2589  * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2590  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2591  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2592  * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2593  */
2594 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2595 	u32 short_ssid;
2596 	u32 channel_idx;
2597 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2598 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2599 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2600 	bool psc_no_listen;
2601 	s8 psd_20;
2602 };
2603 
2604 /**
2605  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2606  *
2607  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2608  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2609  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2610  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2611  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2612  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2613  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2614  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2615  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2616  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2617  *	%duration field.
2618  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2619  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2620  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2621  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2622  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2623  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2624  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2625  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2626  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2627  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2628  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2629  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2630  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2631  *	true if this is the second scan request
2632  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2633  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2634  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2635  * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2636  *      used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2637  */
2638 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2639 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2640 	int n_ssids;
2641 	u32 n_channels;
2642 	const u8 *ie;
2643 	size_t ie_len;
2644 	u16 duration;
2645 	bool duration_mandatory;
2646 	u32 flags;
2647 
2648 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2649 
2650 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2651 
2652 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2653 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2654 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2655 
2656 	/* internal */
2657 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2658 	unsigned long scan_start;
2659 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2660 	bool notified;
2661 	bool no_cck;
2662 	bool scan_6ghz;
2663 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2664 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2665 	s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2666 
2667 	/* keep last */
2668 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2669 };
2670 
2671 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2672 {
2673 	int i;
2674 
2675 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2676 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2677 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2678 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2679 	}
2680 }
2681 
2682 /**
2683  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2684  *
2685  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2686  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2687  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2688  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2689  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2690  * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2691  *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertise this support
2692  *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2693  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2694  *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2695  *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2696  *	corresponding matchset.
2697  */
2698 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2699 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2700 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2701 	s32 rssi_thold;
2702 	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2703 };
2704 
2705 /**
2706  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2707  *
2708  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2709  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2710  *	infinite loop.
2711  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2712  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2713  */
2714 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2715 	u32 interval;
2716 	u32 iterations;
2717 };
2718 
2719 /**
2720  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2721  *
2722  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2723  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2724  */
2725 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2726 	enum nl80211_band band;
2727 	s8 delta;
2728 };
2729 
2730 /**
2731  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2732  *
2733  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2734  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2735  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2736  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2737  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2738  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2739  * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2740  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2741  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2742  *	(others are filtered out).
2743  *	If omitted, all results are passed.
2744  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2745  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2746  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2747  * @dev: the interface
2748  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2749  * @channels: channels to scan
2750  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2751  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2752  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2753  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2754  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2755  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2756  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2757  *	index must be executed first.
2758  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2759  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2760  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2761  *	owned by a particular socket)
2762  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2763  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2764  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2765  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2766  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2767  *	supported.
2768  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2769  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2770  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2771  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2772  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2773  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2774  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2775  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2776  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2777  *	comparisons.
2778  */
2779 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2780 	u64 reqid;
2781 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2782 	int n_ssids;
2783 	u32 n_channels;
2784 	const u8 *ie;
2785 	size_t ie_len;
2786 	u32 flags;
2787 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2788 	int n_match_sets;
2789 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2790 	u32 delay;
2791 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2792 	int n_scan_plans;
2793 
2794 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2795 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2796 
2797 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2798 	s8 relative_rssi;
2799 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2800 
2801 	/* internal */
2802 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2803 	struct net_device *dev;
2804 	unsigned long scan_start;
2805 	bool report_results;
2806 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2807 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2808 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2809 	struct list_head list;
2810 
2811 	/* keep last */
2812 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2813 };
2814 
2815 /**
2816  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2817  *
2818  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2819  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2820  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2821  */
2822 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2823 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2824 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2825 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2826 };
2827 
2828 /**
2829  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2830  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2831  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2832  *	signal type
2833  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2834  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2835  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2836  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2837  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2838  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2839  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2840  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2841  *	by %parent_bssid.
2842  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2843  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2844  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2845  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2846  * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2847  *	%NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2848  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2849  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2850  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2851  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2852  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2853  * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2854  */
2855 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2856 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2857 	s32 signal;
2858 	u64 boottime_ns;
2859 	u64 parent_tsf;
2860 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2861 	u8 chains;
2862 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2863 
2864 	u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2865 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2866 
2867 	void *drv_data;
2868 };
2869 
2870 /**
2871  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2872  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2873  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2874  * @len: length of the IEs
2875  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2876  * @data: IE data
2877  */
2878 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2879 	u64 tsf;
2880 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2881 	int len;
2882 	bool from_beacon;
2883 	u8 data[];
2884 };
2885 
2886 /**
2887  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2888  *
2889  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2890  * for use in scan results and similar.
2891  *
2892  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2893  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2894  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2895  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2896  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2897  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2898  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2899  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2900  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2901  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2902  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2903  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2904  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2905  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2906  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2907  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2908  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2909  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2910  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2911  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2912  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2913  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2914  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2915  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2916  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2917  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2918  * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2919  *	&enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2920  * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2921  *	if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2922  *	unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2923  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2924  */
2925 struct cfg80211_bss {
2926 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2927 
2928 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2929 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2930 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2931 
2932 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2933 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2934 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2935 
2936 	s32 signal;
2937 
2938 	u16 beacon_interval;
2939 	u16 capability;
2940 
2941 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2942 	u8 chains;
2943 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2944 
2945 	u8 bssid_index;
2946 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2947 
2948 	u8 use_for;
2949 	u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2950 
2951 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2952 };
2953 
2954 /**
2955  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2956  * @bss: the bss to search
2957  * @id: the element ID
2958  *
2959  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2960  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2961  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2962  */
2963 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2964 
2965 /**
2966  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2967  * @bss: the bss to search
2968  * @id: the element ID
2969  *
2970  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2971  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2972  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2973  */
2974 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2975 {
2976 	return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2977 }
2978 
2979 
2980 /**
2981  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2982  *
2983  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2984  * authentication.
2985  *
2986  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2987  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2988  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2989  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2990  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2991  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2992  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2993  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2994  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2995  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2996  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2997  *	transaction sequence number field.
2998  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2999  * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3000  *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3001  *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3002  *	given an MLD address) by the driver
3003  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3004  *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3005  */
3006 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3007 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3008 	const u8 *ie;
3009 	size_t ie_len;
3010 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3011 	const u8 *key;
3012 	u8 key_len;
3013 	s8 key_idx;
3014 	const u8 *auth_data;
3015 	size_t auth_data_len;
3016 	s8 link_id;
3017 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3018 };
3019 
3020 /**
3021  * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3022  * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3023  *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3024  * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3025  * @elems_len: length of the elements
3026  * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3027  *	should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3028  * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3029  *	operation as a whole must fail.
3030  */
3031 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3032 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3033 	const u8 *elems;
3034 	size_t elems_len;
3035 	bool disabled;
3036 	int error;
3037 };
3038 
3039 /**
3040  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3041  *
3042  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
3043  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
3044  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3045  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3046  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3047  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3048  *	request (connect callback).
3049  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
3050  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT
3051  * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3052  *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3053  *	flag is not set.
3054  */
3055 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3056 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
3057 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
3058 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
3059 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
3060 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
3061 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5),
3062 	CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6),
3063 };
3064 
3065 /**
3066  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3067  *
3068  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3069  * (re)association.
3070  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3071  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3072  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3073  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3074  *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3075  *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3076  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3077  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3078  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3079  * @crypto: crypto settings
3080  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3081  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3082  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3083  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3084  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3085  *	frame.
3086  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3087  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3088  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3089  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3090  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3091  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3092  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3093  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
3094  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3095  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3096  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3097  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3098  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3099  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3100  * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3101  * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3102  *	the link on which the association request should be sent
3103  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3104  *	valid iff @link_id >= 0
3105  */
3106 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3107 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3108 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3109 	size_t ie_len;
3110 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3111 	bool use_mfp;
3112 	u32 flags;
3113 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3114 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3115 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3116 	const u8 *fils_kek;
3117 	size_t fils_kek_len;
3118 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
3119 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3120 	struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3121 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3122 	s8 link_id;
3123 };
3124 
3125 /**
3126  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3127  *
3128  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3129  * deauthentication.
3130  *
3131  * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3132  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3133  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3134  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3135  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3136  *	do not set a deauth frame
3137  */
3138 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3139 	const u8 *bssid;
3140 	const u8 *ie;
3141 	size_t ie_len;
3142 	u16 reason_code;
3143 	bool local_state_change;
3144 };
3145 
3146 /**
3147  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3148  *
3149  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3150  * disassociation.
3151  *
3152  * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3153  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3154  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3155  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3156  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3157  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3158  */
3159 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3160 	const u8 *ap_addr;
3161 	const u8 *ie;
3162 	size_t ie_len;
3163 	u16 reason_code;
3164 	bool local_state_change;
3165 };
3166 
3167 /**
3168  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3169  *
3170  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3171  * method.
3172  *
3173  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3174  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3175  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3176  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3177  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3178  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3179  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
3180  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3181  * @ie_len: length of that
3182  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3183  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3184  *	after joining
3185  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3186  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3187  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3188  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3189  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3190  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3191  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3192  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3193  *	to operate on DFS channels.
3194  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3195  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3196  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3197  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3198  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3199  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3200  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3201  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3202  */
3203 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3204 	const u8 *ssid;
3205 	const u8 *bssid;
3206 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3207 	const u8 *ie;
3208 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3209 	u16 beacon_interval;
3210 	u32 basic_rates;
3211 	bool channel_fixed;
3212 	bool privacy;
3213 	bool control_port;
3214 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3215 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3216 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3217 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3218 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3219 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
3220 	int wep_tx_key;
3221 };
3222 
3223 /**
3224  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3225  *
3226  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3227  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3228  * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3229  * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3230  */
3231 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3232 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3233 	union {
3234 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3235 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3236 	} param;
3237 };
3238 
3239 /**
3240  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3241  *
3242  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3243  * authentication and association.
3244  *
3245  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3246  *	on scan results)
3247  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3248  *	%NULL if not specified
3249  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3250  *	results)
3251  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3252  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3253  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3254  *	to use.
3255  * @ssid: SSID
3256  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3257  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3258  * @ie: IEs for association request
3259  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3260  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3261  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3262  * @crypto: crypto settings
3263  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3264  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3265  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3266  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3267  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
3268  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3269  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3270  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3271  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3272  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
3273  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3274  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3275  *	networks.
3276  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3277  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3278  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3279  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3280  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3281  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3282  *	frame.
3283  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3284  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3285  *	data IE.
3286  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3287  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3288  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3289  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3290  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3291  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3292  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3293  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3294  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3295  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3296  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3297  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
3298  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3299  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3300  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3301  */
3302 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3303 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3304 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3305 	const u8 *bssid;
3306 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
3307 	const u8 *ssid;
3308 	size_t ssid_len;
3309 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3310 	const u8 *ie;
3311 	size_t ie_len;
3312 	bool privacy;
3313 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3314 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3315 	const u8 *key;
3316 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
3317 	u32 flags;
3318 	int bg_scan_period;
3319 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3320 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3321 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3322 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3323 	bool pbss;
3324 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3325 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
3326 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3327 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3328 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3329 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3330 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3331 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3332 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3333 	bool want_1x;
3334 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3335 };
3336 
3337 /**
3338  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3339  *
3340  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3341  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3342  *
3343  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3344  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3345  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3346  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3347  */
3348 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3349 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
3350 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
3351 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
3352 };
3353 
3354 /**
3355  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3356  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3357  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3358  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3359  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3360  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3361  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3362  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3363  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3364  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3365  */
3366 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3367 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
3368 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
3369 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
3370 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
3371 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
3372 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
3373 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
3374 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
3375 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
3376 };
3377 
3378 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
3379 
3380 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3381 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
3382 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
3383 
3384 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3385 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
3386 
3387 /**
3388  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3389  *
3390  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3391  * caching.
3392  *
3393  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3394  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3395  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3396  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3397  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3398  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3399  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3400  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3401  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3402  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3403  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3404  *	%NULL).
3405  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3406  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3407  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3408  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3409  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3410  *	used for it expires.
3411  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3412  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3413  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3414  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3415  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3416  */
3417 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3418 	const u8 *bssid;
3419 	const u8 *pmkid;
3420 	const u8 *pmk;
3421 	size_t pmk_len;
3422 	const u8 *ssid;
3423 	size_t ssid_len;
3424 	const u8 *cache_id;
3425 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
3426 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3427 };
3428 
3429 /**
3430  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3431  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3432  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3433  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3434  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3435  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3436  *
3437  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3438  * memory, free @mask only!
3439  */
3440 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3441 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3442 	int pattern_len;
3443 	int pkt_offset;
3444 };
3445 
3446 /**
3447  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3448  *
3449  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3450  * @src: source IP address
3451  * @dst: destination IP address
3452  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3453  * @src_port: source port
3454  * @dst_port: destination port
3455  * @payload_len: data payload length
3456  * @payload: data payload buffer
3457  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3458  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3459  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3460  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3461  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3462  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3463  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3464  */
3465 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3466 	struct socket *sock;
3467 	__be32 src, dst;
3468 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3469 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3470 	int payload_len;
3471 	const u8 *payload;
3472 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3473 	u32 data_interval;
3474 	u32 wake_len;
3475 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3476 	u32 tokens_size;
3477 	/* must be last, variable member */
3478 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3479 };
3480 
3481 /**
3482  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3483  *
3484  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3485  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3486  *	operating as normal during suspend
3487  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3488  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3489  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3490  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3491  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3492  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3493  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3494  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3495  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3496  *	NULL if not configured.
3497  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3498  */
3499 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3500 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3501 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3502 	     rfkill_release;
3503 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3504 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3505 	int n_patterns;
3506 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3507 };
3508 
3509 /**
3510  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3511  *
3512  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3513  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3514  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3515  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3516  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3517  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3518  */
3519 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3520 	int delay;
3521 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3522 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3523 	int n_patterns;
3524 };
3525 
3526 /**
3527  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3528  *
3529  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3530  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3531  * @n_rules: number of rules
3532  */
3533 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3534 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3535 	int n_rules;
3536 };
3537 
3538 /**
3539  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3540  *
3541  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3542  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3543  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3544  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3545  *	occurred (in MHz)
3546  */
3547 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3548 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3549 	int n_channels;
3550 	u32 channels[];
3551 };
3552 
3553 /**
3554  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3555  *
3556  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3557  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3558  *	match information.
3559  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3560  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3561  */
3562 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3563 	int n_matches;
3564 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3565 };
3566 
3567 /**
3568  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3569  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3570  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3571  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3572  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3573  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3574  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3575  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3576  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3577  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3578  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3579  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3580  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3581  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3582  *	it is.
3583  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3584  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3585  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3586  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3587  */
3588 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3589 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3590 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3591 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3592 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3593 	s32 pattern_idx;
3594 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3595 	const void *packet;
3596 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3597 };
3598 
3599 /**
3600  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3601  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3602  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3603  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3604  * @kek_len: length of kek
3605  * @kck_len: length of kck
3606  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3607  */
3608 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3609 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3610 	u32 akm;
3611 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3612 };
3613 
3614 /**
3615  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3616  *
3617  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3618  *
3619  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3620  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3621  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3622  */
3623 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3624 	u16 md;
3625 	const u8 *ie;
3626 	size_t ie_len;
3627 };
3628 
3629 /**
3630  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3631  *
3632  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3633  *
3634  * @chan: channel to use
3635  * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3636  * @wait: duration for ROC
3637  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3638  * @len: buffer length
3639  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3640  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3641  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3642  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3643  * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3644  *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3645  *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3646  */
3647 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3648 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3649 	bool offchan;
3650 	unsigned int wait;
3651 	const u8 *buf;
3652 	size_t len;
3653 	bool no_cck;
3654 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3655 	int n_csa_offsets;
3656 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3657 	int link_id;
3658 };
3659 
3660 /**
3661  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3662  *
3663  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3664  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3665  */
3666 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3667 	u8 dscp;
3668 	u8 up;
3669 };
3670 
3671 /**
3672  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3673  *
3674  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3675  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3676  */
3677 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3678 	u8 low;
3679 	u8 high;
3680 };
3681 
3682 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3683 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3684 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3685 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3686 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3687 
3688 /**
3689  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3690  *
3691  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3692  *
3693  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3694  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3695  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3696  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3697  */
3698 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3699 	u8 num_des;
3700 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3701 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3702 };
3703 
3704 /**
3705  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3706  *
3707  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3708  *
3709  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3710  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3711  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3712  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3713  */
3714 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3715 	u8 master_pref;
3716 	u8 bands;
3717 };
3718 
3719 /**
3720  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3721  * configuration
3722  *
3723  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3724  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3725  */
3726 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3727 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3728 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3729 };
3730 
3731 /**
3732  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3733  *
3734  * @filter: the content of the filter
3735  * @len: the length of the filter
3736  */
3737 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3738 	const u8 *filter;
3739 	u8 len;
3740 };
3741 
3742 /**
3743  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3744  *
3745  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3746  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3747  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3748  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3749  *	implementation specific.
3750  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3751  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3752  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3753  * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3754  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3755  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3756  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3757  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3758  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3759  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3760  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3761  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3762  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3763  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3764  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3765  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3766  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3767  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3768  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3769  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3770  */
3771 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3772 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3773 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3774 	u8 publish_type;
3775 	bool close_range;
3776 	bool publish_bcast;
3777 	bool subscribe_active;
3778 	u8 followup_id;
3779 	u8 followup_reqid;
3780 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3781 	u32 ttl;
3782 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3783 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3784 	bool srf_include;
3785 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3786 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3787 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3788 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3789 	int srf_num_macs;
3790 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3791 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3792 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3793 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3794 	u8 instance_id;
3795 	u64 cookie;
3796 };
3797 
3798 /**
3799  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3800  *
3801  * @aa: authenticator address
3802  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3803  * @pmk: the PMK material
3804  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3805  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3806  *	holds PMK-R0.
3807  */
3808 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3809 	const u8 *aa;
3810 	u8 pmk_len;
3811 	const u8 *pmk;
3812 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3813 };
3814 
3815 /**
3816  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3817  *
3818  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3819  *
3820  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3821  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3822  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3823  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3824  *	authentication response command interface.
3825  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3826  *	authentication response command interface.
3827  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3828  *	authentication request event interface.
3829  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3830  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3831  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3832  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3833  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3834  * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3835  *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3836  *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3837  *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3838  *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3839  *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3840  *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3841  *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3842  *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3843  *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3844  *	chosen for the authentication.
3845  */
3846 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3847 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3848 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3849 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3850 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3851 	u16 status;
3852 	const u8 *pmkid;
3853 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3854 };
3855 
3856 /**
3857  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3858  *
3859  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3860  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3861  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3862  *	answered
3863  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3864  *	successfully answered
3865  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3866  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3867  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3868  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3869  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3870  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3871  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3872  *	the responder
3873  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3874  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3875  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3876  */
3877 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3878 	u32 filled;
3879 	u32 success_num;
3880 	u32 partial_num;
3881 	u32 failed_num;
3882 	u32 asap_num;
3883 	u32 non_asap_num;
3884 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3885 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3886 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3887 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3888 };
3889 
3890 /**
3891  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3892  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3893  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3894  *	reason than just "failure"
3895  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3896  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3897  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3898  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3899  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3900  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3901  *	by the responder
3902  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3903  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3904  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3905  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3906  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3907  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3908  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3909  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3910  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3911  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3912  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3913  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3914  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3915  *	the square root of the variance)
3916  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3917  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3918  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3919  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3920  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3921  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3922  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3923  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3924  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3925  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3926  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3927  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3928  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3929  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3930  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3931  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3932  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3933  */
3934 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3935 	const u8 *lci;
3936 	const u8 *civicloc;
3937 	unsigned int lci_len;
3938 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3939 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3940 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3941 	s16 burst_index;
3942 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3943 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3944 	u8 burst_duration;
3945 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3946 	s32 rssi_avg;
3947 	s32 rssi_spread;
3948 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3949 	s64 rtt_avg;
3950 	s64 rtt_variance;
3951 	s64 rtt_spread;
3952 	s64 dist_avg;
3953 	s64 dist_variance;
3954 	s64 dist_spread;
3955 
3956 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3957 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3958 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3959 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3960 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3961 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3962 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3963 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3964 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3965 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3966 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3967 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3968 };
3969 
3970 /**
3971  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3972  * @addr: address of the peer
3973  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3974  *	measurement was made)
3975  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3976  * @status: status of the measurement
3977  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3978  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3979  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3980  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3981  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3982  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3983  * @ftm: FTM result
3984  */
3985 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3986 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3987 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3988 
3989 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3990 
3991 	u8 final:1,
3992 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3993 
3994 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3995 
3996 	union {
3997 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3998 	};
3999 };
4000 
4001 /**
4002  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4003  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4004  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4005  * @burst_period: burst period to use
4006  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4007  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4008  * @burst_duration: burst duration
4009  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4010  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4011  * @request_lci: request LCI information
4012  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4013  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4014  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4015  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4016  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4017  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4018  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
4019  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4020  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4021  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4022  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4023  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4024  *
4025  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4026  */
4027 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4028 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4029 	u16 burst_period;
4030 	u8 requested:1,
4031 	   asap:1,
4032 	   request_lci:1,
4033 	   request_civicloc:1,
4034 	   trigger_based:1,
4035 	   non_trigger_based:1,
4036 	   lmr_feedback:1;
4037 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
4038 	u8 burst_duration;
4039 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
4040 	u8 ftmr_retries;
4041 	u8 bss_color;
4042 };
4043 
4044 /**
4045  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4046  * @addr: MAC address
4047  * @chandef: channel to use
4048  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4049  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4050  */
4051 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4052 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4053 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4054 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4055 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4056 };
4057 
4058 /**
4059  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4060  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4061  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4062  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4063  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4064  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4065  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4066  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4067  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
4068  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4069  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4070  *	zero it means there's no timeout
4071  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4072  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4073  */
4074 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4075 	u64 cookie;
4076 	void *drv_data;
4077 	u32 n_peers;
4078 	u32 nl_portid;
4079 
4080 	u32 timeout;
4081 
4082 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4083 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4084 
4085 	struct list_head list;
4086 
4087 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4088 };
4089 
4090 /**
4091  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4092  *
4093  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4094  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4095  *
4096  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4097  *
4098  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4099  *	has to be done.
4100  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4101  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4102  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4103  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4104  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4105  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4106  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4107  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4108  * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4109  *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4110  *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4111  *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4112  * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4113  *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4114  *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4115  *	with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4116  */
4117 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4118 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4119 	u16 status;
4120 	const u8 *ie;
4121 	size_t ie_len;
4122 	int assoc_link_id;
4123 	u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4124 };
4125 
4126 /**
4127  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4128  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4129  *	for the entire device
4130  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4131  *	for the given interface
4132  * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4133  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4134  *	for these subtypes
4135  */
4136 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4137 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4138 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4139 };
4140 
4141 /**
4142  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4143  *
4144  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4145  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4146  *
4147  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4148  * on success or a negative error code.
4149  *
4150  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4151  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4152  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4153  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4154  *
4155  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4156  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4157  *	configured for the device.
4158  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4159  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4160  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4161  *	the device.
4162  *
4163  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4164  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4165  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4166  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4167  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
4168  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4169  *
4170  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4171  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4172  *
4173  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4174  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4175  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4176  *
4177  * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4178  *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4179  *	address is available.
4180  * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4181  *
4182  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4183  *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4184  *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4185  *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4186  *
4187  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4188  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4189  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4190  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4191  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4192  *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4193  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4194  *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4195  *
4196  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4197  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4198  *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4199  *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4200  *	address for MLO pairwise key.
4201  *
4202  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4203  *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4204  *
4205  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4206  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4207  *
4208  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4209  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4210  *
4211  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4212  *
4213  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4214  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4215  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4216  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4217  *
4218  * @add_station: Add a new station.
4219  * @del_station: Remove a station
4220  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4221  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4222  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4223  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4224  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4225  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4226  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4227  *
4228  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4229  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4230  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4231  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4232  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4233  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4234  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4235  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4236  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4237  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4238  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4239  *
4240  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4241  *
4242  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4243  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4244  *	set, and which to leave alone.
4245  *
4246  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4247  *
4248  * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4249  *	for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4250  *	from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4251  *	The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4252  *	struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4253  *	The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4254  *
4255  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4256  *
4257  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4258  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4259  *	join the mesh instead.
4260  *
4261  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4262  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4263  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4264  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4265  *
4266  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4267  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4268  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4269  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4270  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4271  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4272  *
4273  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4274  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4275  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4276  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4277  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4278  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4279  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4280  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4281  *
4282  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4283  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4284  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4285  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4286  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4287  *	was received.
4288  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4289  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4290  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4291  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4292  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
4293  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4294  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4295  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4296  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
4297  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4298  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4299  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4300  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4301  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4302  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4303  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4304  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4305  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4306  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4307  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4308  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4309  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4310  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
4311  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4312  *
4313  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4314  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4315  *	to a merge.
4316  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4317  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4318  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4319  *
4320  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4321  *	MESH mode)
4322  *
4323  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4324  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4325  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4326  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4327  *
4328  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4329  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4330  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4331  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4332  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4333  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4334  *	return 0 if successful
4335  *
4336  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4337  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4338  *
4339  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4340  *
4341  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4342  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4343  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4344  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4345  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4346  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4347  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4348  *	the duration value.
4349  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4350  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4351  *	frame on another channel
4352  *
4353  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4354  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4355  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4356  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4357  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4358  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4359  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4360  *
4361  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4362  *
4363  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4364  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4365  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4366  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4367  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4368  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4369  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4370  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4371  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4372  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4373  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4374  *	disabled.)
4375  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4376  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
4377  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
4378  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4379  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4380  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4381  *	thresholds.
4382  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4383  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4384  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4385  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4386  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4387  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4388  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
4389  *
4390  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4391  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4392  *
4393  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4394  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4395  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4396  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4397  *
4398  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4399  *
4400  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4401  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4402  *
4403  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4404  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4405  *
4406  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4407  *
4408  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4409  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4410  *	current monitoring channel.
4411  *
4412  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4413  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4414  *
4415  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4416  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4417  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4418  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4419  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4420  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4421  *
4422  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4423  *
4424  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4425  *	was finished on another phy.
4426  *
4427  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4428  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4429  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4430  *
4431  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4432  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4433  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4434  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4435  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
4436  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4437  *
4438  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4439  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4440  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4441  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4442  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4443  *	as soon as possible.
4444  *
4445  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4446  *
4447  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4448  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4449  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4450  *
4451  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4452  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4453  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4454  *	account.
4455  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4456  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4457  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4458  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4459  *	rejected)
4460  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4461  *
4462  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4463  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4464  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4465  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4466  *
4467  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4468  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4469  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4470  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4471  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4472  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4473  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4474  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4475  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4476  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4477  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4478  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4479  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4480  *	provided @nan_func.
4481  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4482  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4483  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4484  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
4485  *
4486  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4487  *
4488  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4489  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4490  *
4491  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4492  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4493  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
4494  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4495  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4496  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4497  *
4498  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4499  *     user space
4500  *
4501  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4502  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4503  *
4504  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4505  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4506  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4507  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4508  *
4509  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4510  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4511  *	DH IE through this interface.
4512  *
4513  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4514  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4515  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4516  *	This callback may sleep.
4517  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4518  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4519  *
4520  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4521  *
4522  * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4523  *
4524  * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4525  *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4526  *	Response frame.
4527  *
4528  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4529  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4530  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4531  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4532  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4533  *	radar channel.
4534  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4535  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4536  * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4537  * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4538  * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4539  *
4540  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4541  * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4542  */
4543 struct cfg80211_ops {
4544 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4545 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4546 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4547 
4548 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4549 						  const char *name,
4550 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4551 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4552 						  struct vif_params *params);
4553 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4554 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4555 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4556 				       struct net_device *dev,
4557 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4558 				       struct vif_params *params);
4559 
4560 	int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4561 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4562 				 unsigned int link_id);
4563 	void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4564 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4565 				 unsigned int link_id);
4566 
4567 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4568 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4569 			   const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4570 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4571 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4572 			   const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4573 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4574 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4575 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4576 			   const u8 *mac_addr);
4577 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4578 				   struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4579 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4580 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4581 					struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4582 					u8 key_index);
4583 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4584 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4585 					  int link_id,
4586 					  u8 key_index);
4587 
4588 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4589 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4590 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4591 				 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4592 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4593 			   unsigned int link_id);
4594 
4595 
4596 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4597 			       const u8 *mac,
4598 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4599 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4600 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4601 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4602 				  const u8 *mac,
4603 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4604 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4605 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4606 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4607 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4608 
4609 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4610 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4611 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4612 			       const u8 *dst);
4613 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4614 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4615 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4616 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4617 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4618 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4619 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4620 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4621 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4622 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4623 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4624 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4625 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4626 				struct net_device *dev,
4627 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4628 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4629 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4630 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4631 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4632 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4633 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4634 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4635 
4636 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4637 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4638 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4639 
4640 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4641 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4642 
4643 	void	(*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4644 			      const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4645 
4646 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4647 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4648 
4649 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4650 					     struct net_device *dev,
4651 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4652 
4653 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4654 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4655 
4656 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4657 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4658 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4659 
4660 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4661 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4662 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4663 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4664 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4665 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4666 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4667 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4668 
4669 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4670 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4671 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4672 					 struct net_device *dev,
4673 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4674 					 u32 changed);
4675 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4676 			      u16 reason_code);
4677 
4678 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4679 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4680 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4681 
4682 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4683 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4684 
4685 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4686 
4687 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4688 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4689 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4690 				int *dbm);
4691 
4692 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4693 
4694 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4695 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4696 				void *data, int len);
4697 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4698 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4699 				 void *data, int len);
4700 #endif
4701 
4702 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4703 				    struct net_device *dev,
4704 				    unsigned int link_id,
4705 				    const u8 *peer,
4706 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4707 
4708 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4709 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4710 
4711 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4712 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4713 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4714 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4715 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4716 
4717 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4718 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4719 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4720 				     unsigned int duration,
4721 				     u64 *cookie);
4722 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4723 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4724 					    u64 cookie);
4725 
4726 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4727 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4728 			   u64 *cookie);
4729 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4730 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4731 				       u64 cookie);
4732 
4733 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4734 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4735 
4736 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4737 				       struct net_device *dev,
4738 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4739 
4740 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4741 					     struct net_device *dev,
4742 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4743 
4744 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4745 				      struct net_device *dev,
4746 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4747 
4748 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4749 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4750 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4751 
4752 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4753 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4754 
4755 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4756 				struct net_device *dev,
4757 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4758 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4759 				   u64 reqid);
4760 
4761 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4762 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4763 
4764 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4765 			     const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4766 			     u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4767 			     u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4768 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4769 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4770 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4771 
4772 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4773 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4774 
4775 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4776 				  struct net_device *dev,
4777 				  u16 noack_map);
4778 
4779 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4780 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4781 			       unsigned int link_id,
4782 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4783 
4784 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4785 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4786 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4787 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4788 
4789 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4790 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4791 
4792 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4793 					 struct net_device *dev,
4794 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4795 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4796 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4797 				struct net_device *dev);
4798 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4799 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4800 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4801 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4802 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4803 				    u16 duration);
4804 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4805 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4806 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4807 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4808 
4809 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4810 				  struct net_device *dev,
4811 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4812 
4813 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4814 			       struct net_device *dev,
4815 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4816 
4817 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4818 				    unsigned int link_id,
4819 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4820 
4821 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4822 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4823 			     u16 admitted_time);
4824 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4825 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4826 
4827 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4828 				       struct net_device *dev,
4829 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4830 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4831 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4832 					      struct net_device *dev,
4833 					      const u8 *addr);
4834 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4835 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4836 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4837 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4838 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4839 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4840 			       u64 cookie);
4841 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4842 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4843 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4844 				   u32 changes);
4845 
4846 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4847 					    struct net_device *dev,
4848 					    const bool enabled);
4849 
4850 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4851 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4852 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4853 
4854 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4855 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4856 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4857 			   const u8 *aa);
4858 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4859 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4860 
4861 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4862 				   struct net_device *dev,
4863 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4864 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4865 				   const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4866 				   u64 *cookie);
4867 
4868 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4869 				struct net_device *dev,
4870 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4871 
4872 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4873 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4874 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4875 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4876 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4877 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4878 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4879 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4880 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4881 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4882 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4883 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4884 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4885 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4886 	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4887 				struct net_device *dev,
4888 				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4889 	int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4890 				struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4891 	int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4892 					struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4893 	int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4894 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4895 	int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4896 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4897 	int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4898 				    struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4899 	int	(*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4900 				    struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4901 	int	(*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4902 			    struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
4903 };
4904 
4905 /*
4906  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4907  * and registration/helper functions
4908  */
4909 
4910 /**
4911  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4912  *
4913  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4914  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4915  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4916  *	wiphy at all
4917  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4918  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4919  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4920  *	reason to override the default
4921  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4922  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4923  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4924  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4925  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4926  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4927  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4928  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4929  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4930  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4931  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4932  *	firmware.
4933  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4934  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4935  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4936  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4937  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4938  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4939  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4940  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4941  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4942  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4943  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4944  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4945  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4946  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4947  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4948  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4949  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4950  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4951  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4952  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
4953  *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
4954  *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
4955  *	should set this flag for now.
4956  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
4957  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
4958  *	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
4959  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
4960  *	set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
4961  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
4962  *	of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
4963  */
4964 enum wiphy_flags {
4965 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4966 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1),
4967 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4968 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4969 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4970 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4971 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4972 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4973 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4974 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4975 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11),
4976 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= BIT(12),
4977 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4978 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4979 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4980 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4981 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4982 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4983 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4984 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4985 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4986 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4987 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4988 	WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER	= BIT(24),
4989 	WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON     = BIT(25),
4990 };
4991 
4992 /**
4993  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4994  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4995  * @types: interface types (bits)
4996  */
4997 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4998 	u16 max;
4999 	u16 types;
5000 };
5001 
5002 /**
5003  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5004  *
5005  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5006  * combinations it supports concurrently.
5007  *
5008  * Examples:
5009  *
5010  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5011  *
5012  *    .. code-block:: c
5013  *
5014  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5015  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5016  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5017  *	};
5018  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5019  *		.limits = limits1,
5020  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5021  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
5022  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5023  *	};
5024  *
5025  *
5026  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5027  *
5028  *    .. code-block:: c
5029  *
5030  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5031  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5032  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5033  *	};
5034  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5035  *		.limits = limits2,
5036  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5037  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
5038  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
5039  *	};
5040  *
5041  *
5042  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5043  *
5044  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5045  *
5046  *    .. code-block:: c
5047  *
5048  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5049  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5050  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5051  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5052  *	};
5053  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5054  *		.limits = limits3,
5055  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5056  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
5057  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
5058  *	};
5059  *
5060  */
5061 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5062 	/**
5063 	 * @limits:
5064 	 * limits for the given interface types
5065 	 */
5066 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5067 
5068 	/**
5069 	 * @num_different_channels:
5070 	 * can use up to this many different channels
5071 	 */
5072 	u32 num_different_channels;
5073 
5074 	/**
5075 	 * @max_interfaces:
5076 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5077 	 */
5078 	u16 max_interfaces;
5079 
5080 	/**
5081 	 * @n_limits:
5082 	 * number of limitations
5083 	 */
5084 	u8 n_limits;
5085 
5086 	/**
5087 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5088 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5089 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5090 	 */
5091 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5092 
5093 	/**
5094 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
5095 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5096 	 */
5097 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
5098 
5099 	/**
5100 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
5101 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5102 	 */
5103 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
5104 
5105 	/**
5106 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5107 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5108 	 *
5109 	 * = 0
5110 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5111 	 * > 0
5112 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5113 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5114 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5115 	 */
5116 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5117 };
5118 
5119 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5120 	u16 tx, rx;
5121 };
5122 
5123 /**
5124  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5125  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5126  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5127  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5128  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5129  *	packet should be preserved in that case
5130  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5131  *	(see nl80211.h)
5132  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5133  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5134  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5135  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5136  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5137  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5138  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5139  */
5140 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5141 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
5142 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
5143 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
5144 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
5145 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
5146 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
5147 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
5148 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
5149 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
5150 };
5151 
5152 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5153 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5154 	u32 data_payload_max;
5155 	u32 data_interval_max;
5156 	u32 wake_payload_max;
5157 	bool seq;
5158 };
5159 
5160 /**
5161  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5162  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5163  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5164  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5165  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5166  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5167  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5168  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5169  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5170  *	scheduled scans.
5171  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5172  *	details.
5173  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5174  */
5175 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5176 	u32 flags;
5177 	int n_patterns;
5178 	int pattern_max_len;
5179 	int pattern_min_len;
5180 	int max_pkt_offset;
5181 	int max_nd_match_sets;
5182 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5183 };
5184 
5185 /**
5186  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5187  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5188  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5189  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5190  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5191  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5192  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5193  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5194  */
5195 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5196 	int n_rules;
5197 	int max_delay;
5198 	int n_patterns;
5199 	int pattern_max_len;
5200 	int pattern_min_len;
5201 	int max_pkt_offset;
5202 };
5203 
5204 /**
5205  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5206  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5207  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5208  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5209  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5210  */
5211 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5212 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5213 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5214 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5215 };
5216 
5217 /**
5218  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5219  *
5220  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5221  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5222  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5223  *
5224  */
5225 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5226 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
5227 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
5228 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
5229 };
5230 
5231 /**
5232  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5233  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5234  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5235  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5236  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5237  */
5238 
5239 struct sta_opmode_info {
5240 	u32 changed;
5241 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5242 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5243 	u8 rx_nss;
5244 };
5245 
5246 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5247 
5248 /**
5249  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5250  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5251  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5252  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5253  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5254  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5255  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5256  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5257  *	dumpit calls.
5258  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5259  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5260  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5261  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5262  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5263  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5264  * are used with dump requests.
5265  */
5266 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5267 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5268 	u32 flags;
5269 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5270 		    const void *data, int data_len);
5271 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5272 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5273 		      unsigned long *storage);
5274 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
5275 	unsigned int maxattr;
5276 };
5277 
5278 /**
5279  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5280  * @iftype: interface type
5281  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5282  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5283  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5284  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5285  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5286  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5287  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5288  * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5289  * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5290  */
5291 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5292 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5293 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5294 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5295 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5296 	u16 eml_capabilities;
5297 	u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5298 };
5299 
5300 /**
5301  * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5302  * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5303  * @type: the interface type to look up
5304  */
5305 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5306 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5307 
5308 /**
5309  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5310  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5311  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5312  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5313  * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5314  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5315  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5316  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5317  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5318  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5319  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5320  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5321  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5322  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5323  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5324  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5325  *	not limited)
5326  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5327  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5328  */
5329 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5330 	unsigned int max_peers;
5331 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5332 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
5333 
5334 	struct {
5335 		u32 preambles;
5336 		u32 bandwidths;
5337 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5338 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5339 		u8 supported:1,
5340 		   asap:1,
5341 		   non_asap:1,
5342 		   request_lci:1,
5343 		   request_civicloc:1,
5344 		   trigger_based:1,
5345 		   non_trigger_based:1;
5346 	} ftm;
5347 };
5348 
5349 /**
5350  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5351  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5352  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5353  *
5354  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5355  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5356  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5357  */
5358 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5359 	u16 iftypes_mask;
5360 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5361 	int n_akm_suites;
5362 };
5363 
5364 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS	0xffff
5365 
5366 /**
5367  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5368  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5369  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5370  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5371  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5372  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5373  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5374  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5375  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5376  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5377  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5378  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5379  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5380  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5381  *	iftype_akm_suites.
5382  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5383  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5384  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5385  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5386  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5387  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5388  *	suites are specified separately.
5389  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5390  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5391  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5392  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5393  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5394  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5395  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5396  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5397  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5398  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5399  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5400  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5401  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5402  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5403  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5404  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5405  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5406  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5407  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5408  *	unregister hardware
5409  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5410  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5411  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5412  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5413  *	(see below).
5414  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5415  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5416  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5417  *	must be set by driver
5418  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5419  *	list single interface types.
5420  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5421  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5422  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5423  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5424  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5425  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5426  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5427  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5428  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5429  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5430  *	this variable determines its size
5431  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5432  *	any given scan
5433  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5434  *	the device can run concurrently.
5435  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5436  *	for in any given scheduled scan
5437  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5438  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5439  *	supported.
5440  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5441  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5442  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
5443  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5444  *	scans
5445  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5446  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5447  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5448  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
5449  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5450  *	scan plan supported by the device.
5451  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5452  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5453  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5454  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5455  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5456  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5457  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5458  *
5459  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5460  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5461  *	type
5462  *
5463  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5464  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5465  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5466  *
5467  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5468  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5469  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5470  *
5471  * @probe_resp_offload:
5472  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5473  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5474  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5475  *
5476  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5477  *	may request, if implemented.
5478  *
5479  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5480  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5481  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5482  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
5483  *
5484  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5485  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5486  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5487  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5488  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5489  *
5490  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5491  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5492  *
5493  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5494  *	supports for ACL.
5495  *
5496  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5497  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5498  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5499  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5500  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5501  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5502  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5503  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5504  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5505  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5506  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5507  *	capabilities are specified separately.
5508  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5509  *
5510  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5511  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5512  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5513  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5514  *
5515  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5516  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5517  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5518  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
5519  *
5520  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5521  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
5522  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5523  *	infinite.
5524  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5525  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5526  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5527  *
5528  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5529  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
5530  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5531  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5532  *
5533  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5534  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5535  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5536  *
5537  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5538  *	wake_tx_queue
5539  *
5540  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5541  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5542  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5543  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5544  *
5545  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5546  *
5547  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5548  *	device has
5549  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5550  *	supported by the driver for each vif
5551  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5552  *	supported by the driver for each peer
5553  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5554  *	long/short retry configuration
5555  *
5556  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5557  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5558  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5559  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5560  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5561  *
5562  * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5563  *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5564  *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5565  * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5566  *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5567  *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5568  * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5569  *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5570  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5571  *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5572  *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5573  *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5574  *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5575  *
5576  * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5577  *	enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5578  *	non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5579  *	A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5580  *	supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5581  *	specify a mac address).
5582  */
5583 struct wiphy {
5584 	struct mutex mtx;
5585 
5586 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5587 
5588 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5589 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5590 
5591 	struct mac_address *addresses;
5592 
5593 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5594 
5595 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5596 	int n_iface_combinations;
5597 	u16 software_iftypes;
5598 
5599 	u16 n_addresses;
5600 
5601 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5602 	u16 interface_modes;
5603 
5604 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5605 
5606 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5607 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5608 
5609 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5610 
5611 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5612 
5613 	int bss_priv_size;
5614 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5615 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5616 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5617 	u8 max_match_sets;
5618 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5619 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5620 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5621 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5622 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5623 
5624 	int n_cipher_suites;
5625 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5626 
5627 	int n_akm_suites;
5628 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5629 
5630 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5631 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5632 
5633 	u8 retry_short;
5634 	u8 retry_long;
5635 	u32 frag_threshold;
5636 	u32 rts_threshold;
5637 	u8 coverage_class;
5638 
5639 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5640 	u32 hw_version;
5641 
5642 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5643 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5644 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5645 #endif
5646 
5647 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5648 
5649 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5650 
5651 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5652 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5653 
5654 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5655 
5656 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5657 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5658 
5659 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5660 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5661 
5662 	const void *privid;
5663 
5664 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5665 
5666 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5667 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5668 
5669 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5670 
5671 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5672 
5673 	struct device dev;
5674 
5675 	bool registered;
5676 
5677 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5678 
5679 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5680 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5681 
5682 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5683 
5684 	possible_net_t _net;
5685 
5686 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5687 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5688 #endif
5689 
5690 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5691 
5692 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5693 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5694 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5695 
5696 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5697 
5698 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5699 
5700 	u32 bss_select_support;
5701 
5702 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5703 
5704 	u32 txq_limit;
5705 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5706 	u32 txq_quantum;
5707 
5708 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5709 
5710 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5711 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5712 
5713 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5714 
5715 	struct {
5716 		u64 peer, vif;
5717 		u8 max_retry;
5718 	} tid_config_support;
5719 
5720 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5721 
5722 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5723 
5724 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5725 
5726 	u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5727 	u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5728 	u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5729 
5730 	u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5731 
5732 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5733 };
5734 
5735 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5736 {
5737 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5738 }
5739 
5740 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5741 {
5742 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5743 }
5744 
5745 /**
5746  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5747  *
5748  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5749  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5750  */
5751 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5752 {
5753 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5754 	return &wiphy->priv;
5755 }
5756 
5757 /**
5758  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5759  *
5760  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5761  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5762  */
5763 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5764 {
5765 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5766 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5767 }
5768 
5769 /**
5770  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5771  *
5772  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5773  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5774  */
5775 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5776 {
5777 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5778 }
5779 
5780 /**
5781  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5782  *
5783  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5784  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5785  */
5786 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5787 {
5788 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5789 }
5790 
5791 /**
5792  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5793  *
5794  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5795  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5796  */
5797 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5798 {
5799 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5800 }
5801 
5802 /**
5803  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5804  *
5805  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5806  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5807  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5808  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5809  *
5810  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5811  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5812  *
5813  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5814  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5815  */
5816 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5817 			   const char *requested_name);
5818 
5819 /**
5820  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5821  *
5822  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5823  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5824  *
5825  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5826  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5827  *
5828  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5829  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5830  */
5831 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5832 				      int sizeof_priv)
5833 {
5834 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5835 }
5836 
5837 /**
5838  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5839  *
5840  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5841  *
5842  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5843  */
5844 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5845 
5846 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5847 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5848 
5849 /**
5850  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5851  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5852  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5853  *
5854  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5855  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5856  */
5857 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5858         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5859 
5860 /**
5861  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5862  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5863  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5864  *
5865  * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5866  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5867  */
5868 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5869         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5870 
5871 /**
5872  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5873  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5874  */
5875 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5876 
5877 /**
5878  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5879  *
5880  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5881  *
5882  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5883  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5884  * request that is being handled.
5885  */
5886 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5887 
5888 /**
5889  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5890  *
5891  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5892  */
5893 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5894 
5895 /* internal structs */
5896 struct cfg80211_conn;
5897 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5898 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5899 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5900 
5901 /**
5902  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5903  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5904  *
5905  * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
5906  * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
5907  * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
5908  * differentiate which way it's called.
5909  *
5910  * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
5911  *
5912  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5913  *
5914  * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
5915  * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
5916  */
5917 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5918 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5919 {
5920 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5921 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5922 }
5923 
5924 /**
5925  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5926  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5927  */
5928 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5929 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5930 {
5931 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5932 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5933 }
5934 
5935 struct wiphy_work;
5936 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
5937 
5938 struct wiphy_work {
5939 	struct list_head entry;
5940 	wiphy_work_func_t func;
5941 };
5942 
5943 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
5944 				   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5945 {
5946 	INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
5947 	work->func = func;
5948 }
5949 
5950 /**
5951  * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
5952  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5953  * @work: the work item
5954  *
5955  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5956  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
5957  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
5958  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
5959  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
5960  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
5961  */
5962 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5963 
5964 /**
5965  * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
5966  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5967  * @work: the work to cancel
5968  *
5969  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
5970  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5971  */
5972 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5973 
5974 /**
5975  * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
5976  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5977  * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
5978  *
5979  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
5980  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5981  */
5982 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5983 
5984 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
5985 	struct wiphy_work work;
5986 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5987 	struct timer_list timer;
5988 };
5989 
5990 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
5991 
5992 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
5993 					   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5994 {
5995 	timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
5996 	wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
5997 }
5998 
5999 /**
6000  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6001  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6002  * @dwork: the delayable worker
6003  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6004  *
6005  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6006  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6007  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6008  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6009  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6010  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6011  */
6012 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6013 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6014 			      unsigned long delay);
6015 
6016 /**
6017  * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6018  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6019  * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6020  *
6021  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6022  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6023  */
6024 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6025 			       struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6026 
6027 /**
6028  * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6029  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6030  * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6031  *
6032  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6033  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6034  */
6035 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6036 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6037 
6038 /**
6039  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6040  *
6041  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6042  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6043  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6044  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6045  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6046  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6047  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6048  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6049  *
6050  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6051  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6052  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6053  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6054  *
6055  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6056  * @iftype: interface type
6057  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6058  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6059  *	for the notifier
6060  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6061  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6062  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6063  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
6064  * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6065  * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6066  * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
6067  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6068  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6069  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6070  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6071  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6072  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6073  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6074  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6075  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6076  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6077  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6078  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6079  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6080  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6081  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6082  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
6083  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6084  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6085  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
6086  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
6087  *	beacons, 0 when not valid
6088  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6089  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6090  *	the P2P Device.
6091  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
6092  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
6093  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6094  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6095  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6096  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6097  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6098  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6099  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6100  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6101  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6102  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6103  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6104  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6105  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6106  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6107  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6108  * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6109  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6110  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6111  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6112  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6113  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6114  *	unprotected beacon report
6115  * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6116  *	@ap and @client for each link
6117  * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6118  */
6119 struct wireless_dev {
6120 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
6121 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6122 
6123 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6124 	struct list_head list;
6125 	struct net_device *netdev;
6126 
6127 	u32 identifier;
6128 
6129 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6130 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6131 
6132 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6133 
6134 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6135 
6136 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6137 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6138 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6139 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6140 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6141 
6142 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6143 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6144 
6145 	struct list_head event_list;
6146 	spinlock_t event_lock;
6147 
6148 	u8 connected:1;
6149 
6150 	bool ps;
6151 	int ps_timeout;
6152 
6153 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6154 
6155 	u32 owner_nlportid;
6156 	bool nl_owner_dead;
6157 
6158 	/* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */
6159 	bool cac_started;
6160 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
6161 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6162 
6163 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6164 	/* wext data */
6165 	struct {
6166 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6167 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6168 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6169 		const u8 *ie;
6170 		size_t ie_len;
6171 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6172 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6173 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6174 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6175 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
6176 	} wext;
6177 #endif
6178 
6179 	struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6180 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6181 
6182 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
6183 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6184 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6185 
6186 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6187 
6188 	union {
6189 		struct {
6190 			u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6191 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6192 			u8 ssid_len;
6193 		} client;
6194 		struct {
6195 			int beacon_interval;
6196 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6197 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6198 			u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6199 			u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6200 		} mesh;
6201 		struct {
6202 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6203 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6204 			u8 ssid_len;
6205 		} ap;
6206 		struct {
6207 			struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6208 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6209 			int beacon_interval;
6210 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6211 			u8 ssid_len;
6212 		} ibss;
6213 		struct {
6214 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6215 		} ocb;
6216 	} u;
6217 
6218 	struct {
6219 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6220 		union {
6221 			struct {
6222 				unsigned int beacon_interval;
6223 				struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6224 			} ap;
6225 			struct {
6226 				struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6227 			} client;
6228 		};
6229 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6230 	u16 valid_links;
6231 };
6232 
6233 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6234 {
6235 	if (wdev->netdev)
6236 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6237 	return wdev->address;
6238 }
6239 
6240 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6241 {
6242 	if (wdev->netdev)
6243 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6244 	return wdev->is_running;
6245 }
6246 
6247 /**
6248  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6249  *
6250  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6251  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6252  */
6253 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6254 {
6255 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
6256 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6257 }
6258 
6259 /**
6260  * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6261  * @wdev: the wdev
6262  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6263  *
6264  * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6265  */
6266 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6267 				       unsigned int link_id);
6268 
6269 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6270 					unsigned int link_id)
6271 {
6272 	WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6273 	WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6274 		!(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6275 }
6276 
6277 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\
6278 	for (link_id = 0;					\
6279 	     link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\
6280 			ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\
6281 	     link_id++)						\
6282 		if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\
6283 		    ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6284 
6285 /**
6286  * DOC: Utility functions
6287  *
6288  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6289  */
6290 
6291 /**
6292  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6293  *
6294  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6295  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6296  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6297  */
6298 static inline bool
6299 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6300 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6301 {
6302 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6303 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6304 }
6305 
6306 /**
6307  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6308  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6309  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6310  */
6311 static inline u32
6312 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6313 {
6314 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6315 }
6316 
6317 /**
6318  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6319  *
6320  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6321  * @chan: channel
6322  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6323  */
6324 enum nl80211_chan_width
6325 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6326 
6327 /**
6328  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6329  * @chan: channel number
6330  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6331  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6332  */
6333 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6334 
6335 /**
6336  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6337  * @chan: channel number
6338  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6339  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6340  */
6341 static inline int
6342 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6343 {
6344 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6345 }
6346 
6347 /**
6348  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6349  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6350  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6351  */
6352 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6353 
6354 /**
6355  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6356  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6357  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6358  */
6359 static inline int
6360 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6361 {
6362 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6363 }
6364 
6365 /**
6366  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6367  * frequency
6368  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6369  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6370  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6371  */
6372 struct ieee80211_channel *
6373 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6374 
6375 /**
6376  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6377  *
6378  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6379  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6380  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6381  */
6382 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
6383 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6384 {
6385 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6386 }
6387 
6388 /**
6389  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6390  * @chan: control channel to check
6391  *
6392  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6393  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6394  */
6395 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6396 {
6397 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6398 		return false;
6399 
6400 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6401 }
6402 
6403 /**
6404  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6405  *
6406  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6407  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6408  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6409  *
6410  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6411  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6412  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6413  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6414  */
6415 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6416 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6417 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6418 
6419 /**
6420  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6421  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6422  *
6423  * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
6424  * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6425  */
6426 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6427 
6428 /*
6429  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6430  *
6431  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6432  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6433  */
6434 
6435 struct radiotap_align_size {
6436 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6437 };
6438 
6439 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6440 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6441 	int n_bits;
6442 	uint32_t oui;
6443 	uint8_t subns;
6444 };
6445 
6446 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6447 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6448 	int n_ns;
6449 };
6450 
6451 /**
6452  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6453  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6454  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6455  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6456  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6457  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6458  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
6459  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6460  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6461  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6462  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6463  *	radiotap namespace or not
6464  *
6465  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6466  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6467  * @_arg_index: next argument index
6468  * @_arg: next argument pointer
6469  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6470  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6471  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6472  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6473  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6474  *	next bitmap word
6475  *
6476  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6477  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6478  */
6479 
6480 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6481 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6482 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6483 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6484 
6485 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6486 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
6487 
6488 	unsigned char *this_arg;
6489 	int this_arg_index;
6490 	int this_arg_size;
6491 
6492 	int is_radiotap_ns;
6493 
6494 	int _max_length;
6495 	int _arg_index;
6496 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6497 	int _reset_on_ext;
6498 };
6499 
6500 int
6501 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6502 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6503 				 int max_length,
6504 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6505 
6506 int
6507 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6508 
6509 
6510 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6511 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6512 
6513 /**
6514  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6515  *
6516  * @skb: the frame
6517  *
6518  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6519  * returns the 802.11 header length.
6520  *
6521  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6522  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6523  * 802.11 header.
6524  */
6525 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6526 
6527 /**
6528  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6529  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6530  * Return: The header length in bytes.
6531  */
6532 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6533 
6534 /**
6535  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6536  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6537  *	(first byte) will be accessed
6538  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6539  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6540  */
6541 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6542 
6543 /**
6544  * DOC: Data path helpers
6545  *
6546  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6547  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6548  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6549  */
6550 
6551 /**
6552  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6553  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6554  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6555  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
6556  * @addr: the device MAC address
6557  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6558  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6559  * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6560  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6561  */
6562 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6563 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6564 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6565 
6566 /**
6567  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6568  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6569  * @addr: the device MAC address
6570  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6571  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6572  */
6573 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6574 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6575 {
6576 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6577 }
6578 
6579 /**
6580  * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6581  *
6582  * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6583  * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6584  * mesh control field.
6585  *
6586  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6587  * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6588  *	0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6589  *	1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6590  *	2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6591  * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6592  */
6593 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6594 
6595 /**
6596  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6597  *
6598  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6599  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6600  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6601  *
6602  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6603  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6604  *	initialized by the caller.
6605  * @addr: The device MAC address.
6606  * @iftype: The device interface type.
6607  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6608  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6609  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6610  * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6611  */
6612 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6613 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6614 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6615 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6616 			      u8 mesh_control);
6617 
6618 /**
6619  * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6620  *
6621  * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6622  * protocol.
6623  *
6624  * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6625  * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6626  * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6627  */
6628 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6629 
6630 /**
6631  * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6632  *
6633  * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6634  * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6635  * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6636  *
6637  * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6638  */
6639 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6640 
6641 /**
6642  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6643  * @skb: the data frame
6644  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6645  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6646  */
6647 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6648 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6649 
6650 /**
6651  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6652  *
6653  * @eid: element ID
6654  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6655  * @len: length of data
6656  * @match: byte array to match
6657  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6658  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6659  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6660  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6661  *	the data portion instead.
6662  *
6663  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6664  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6665  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6666  * requested element struct.
6667  *
6668  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6669  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6670  * byte array to match.
6671  */
6672 const struct element *
6673 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6674 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6675 			 unsigned int match_offset);
6676 
6677 /**
6678  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6679  *
6680  * @eid: element ID
6681  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6682  * @len: length of data
6683  * @match: byte array to match
6684  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6685  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6686  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6687  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6688  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6689  *	the second byte is the IE length.
6690  *
6691  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6692  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6693  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6694  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6695  * element ID.
6696  *
6697  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6698  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6699  * byte array to match.
6700  */
6701 static inline const u8 *
6702 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6703 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6704 		       unsigned int match_offset)
6705 {
6706 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6707 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6708 	 */
6709 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6710 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
6711 		return NULL;
6712 
6713 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6714 						      match, match_len,
6715 						      match_offset ?
6716 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
6717 }
6718 
6719 /**
6720  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6721  *
6722  * @eid: element ID
6723  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6724  * @len: length of data
6725  *
6726  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6727  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6728  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6729  * requested element struct.
6730  *
6731  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6732  * having to fit into the given data.
6733  */
6734 static inline const struct element *
6735 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6736 {
6737 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6738 }
6739 
6740 /**
6741  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6742  *
6743  * @eid: element ID
6744  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6745  * @len: length of data
6746  *
6747  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6748  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6749  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6750  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6751  *
6752  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6753  * having to fit into the given data.
6754  */
6755 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6756 {
6757 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6758 }
6759 
6760 /**
6761  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6762  *
6763  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6764  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6765  * @len: length of data
6766  *
6767  * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
6768  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6769  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6770  * requested element struct.
6771  *
6772  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6773  * having to fit into the given data.
6774  */
6775 static inline const struct element *
6776 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6777 {
6778 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6779 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
6780 }
6781 
6782 /**
6783  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
6784  *
6785  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6786  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6787  * @len: length of data
6788  *
6789  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
6790  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6791  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6792  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6793  *
6794  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6795  * having to fit into the given data.
6796  */
6797 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6798 {
6799 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6800 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
6801 }
6802 
6803 /**
6804  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6805  *
6806  * @oui: vendor OUI
6807  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6808  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6809  * @len: length of data
6810  *
6811  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6812  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6813  * return the element structure for the requested element.
6814  *
6815  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6816  * the given data.
6817  */
6818 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6819 						const u8 *ies,
6820 						unsigned int len);
6821 
6822 /**
6823  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6824  *
6825  * @oui: vendor OUI
6826  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6827  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6828  * @len: length of data
6829  *
6830  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6831  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6832  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6833  * element ID.
6834  *
6835  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6836  * the given data.
6837  */
6838 static inline const u8 *
6839 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6840 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6841 {
6842 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6843 }
6844 
6845 /**
6846  * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
6847  *
6848  * @elem: the element to defragment
6849  * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
6850  * @ieslen: length of @ies
6851  * @data: buffer to store element data
6852  * @data_len: length of @data
6853  * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
6854  *
6855  * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
6856  *
6857  * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
6858  * skipping all headers.
6859  *
6860  * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
6861  * element in-place.
6862  */
6863 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
6864 				    size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
6865 				    u8 frag_id);
6866 
6867 /**
6868  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6869  *
6870  * @dev: network device
6871  * @addr: STA MAC address
6872  *
6873  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6874  * devices upon STA association.
6875  */
6876 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6877 
6878 /**
6879  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6880  *
6881  * TODO
6882  */
6883 
6884 /**
6885  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6886  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6887  *	conflicts)
6888  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6889  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6890  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6891  *	alpha2.
6892  *
6893  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6894  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6895  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6896  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6897  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6898  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6899  *
6900  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6901  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6902  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6903  *
6904  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6905  * an -ENOMEM.
6906  *
6907  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6908  */
6909 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6910 
6911 /**
6912  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6913  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6914  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6915  *
6916  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6917  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6918  * information.
6919  *
6920  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6921  */
6922 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6923 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6924 
6925 /**
6926  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
6927  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6928  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6929  *
6930  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
6931  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
6932  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
6933  *
6934  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6935  */
6936 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6937 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6938 
6939 /**
6940  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
6941  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6942  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
6943  *
6944  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
6945  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
6946  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
6947  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
6948  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
6949  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
6950  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
6951  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
6952  * that called this helper.
6953  */
6954 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6955 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
6956 
6957 /**
6958  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
6959  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
6960  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
6961  *
6962  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
6963  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
6964  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
6965  * and processed already.
6966  *
6967  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
6968  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
6969  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
6970  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
6971  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
6972  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
6973  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
6974  */
6975 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6976 					       u32 center_freq);
6977 
6978 /**
6979  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
6980  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
6981  *
6982  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
6983  * proper string representation.
6984  */
6985 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
6986 
6987 /**
6988  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
6989  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
6990  *
6991  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
6992  */
6993 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6994 
6995 /**
6996  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
6997  *
6998  */
6999 
7000 /**
7001  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7002  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7003  *
7004  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7005  * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7006  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7007  *
7008  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
7009  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7010  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7011  *
7012  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7013  * an -ENODATA.
7014  *
7015  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7016  */
7017 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7018 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7019 
7020 /*
7021  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7022  * functions and BSS handling helpers
7023  */
7024 
7025 /**
7026  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7027  *
7028  * @request: the corresponding scan request
7029  * @info: information about the completed scan
7030  */
7031 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7032 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7033 
7034 /**
7035  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7036  *
7037  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7038  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7039  */
7040 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7041 
7042 /**
7043  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7044  *
7045  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7046  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7047  *
7048  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7049  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7050  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7051  */
7052 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7053 
7054 /**
7055  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7056  *
7057  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7058  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7059  *
7060  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7061  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
7062  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7063  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7064  */
7065 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7066 
7067 /**
7068  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7069  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7070  * @data: the BSS metadata
7071  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7072  * @len: length of the management frame
7073  * @gfp: context flags
7074  *
7075  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7076  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7077  *
7078  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7079  * Or %NULL on error.
7080  */
7081 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7082 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7083 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7084 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7085 			       gfp_t gfp);
7086 
7087 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7088 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7089 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7090 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7091 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7092 {
7093 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7094 		.chan = rx_channel,
7095 		.signal = signal,
7096 	};
7097 
7098 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7099 }
7100 
7101 /**
7102  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7103  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7104  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7105  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7106  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7107  */
7108 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7109 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7110 {
7111 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7112 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7113 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
7114 
7115 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7116 
7117 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7118 
7119 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7120 }
7121 
7122 /**
7123  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7124  * @element: element to check
7125  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7126  */
7127 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7128 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7129 
7130 /**
7131  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7132  * @ie: ies
7133  * @ielen: length of IEs
7134  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7135  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7136  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7137  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7138  */
7139 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7140 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7141 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
7142 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7143 
7144 /**
7145  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7146  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7147  *	from a beacon or probe response
7148  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7149  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7150  */
7151 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7152 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7153 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7154 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7155 };
7156 
7157 /**
7158  * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7159  * @ie: IEs
7160  * @ielen: length of IEs
7161  * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7162  *
7163  * Returns the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7164  */
7165 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7166 				    enum nl80211_band band);
7167 
7168 /**
7169  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7170  *
7171  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7172  * @data: the BSS metadata
7173  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7174  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7175  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7176  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7177  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7178  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7179  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7180  * @gfp: context flags
7181  *
7182  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7183  * the BSS should be updated/added.
7184  *
7185  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7186  * Or %NULL on error.
7187  */
7188 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7189 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7190 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7191 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7192 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7193 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7194 			 gfp_t gfp);
7195 
7196 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7197 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7198 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7199 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7200 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7201 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7202 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7203 {
7204 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7205 		.chan = rx_channel,
7206 		.signal = signal,
7207 	};
7208 
7209 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7210 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7211 					gfp);
7212 }
7213 
7214 /**
7215  * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7216  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7217  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7218  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7219  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7220  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7221  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7222  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7223  * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7224  */
7225 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7226 					struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7227 					const u8 *bssid,
7228 					const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7229 					enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7230 					enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7231 					u32 use_for);
7232 
7233 /**
7234  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7235  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7236  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7237  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7238  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7239  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7240  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7241  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7242  *
7243  * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7244  */
7245 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
7246 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7247 		 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7248 		 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7249 		 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7250 {
7251 	return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7252 				  bss_type, privacy,
7253 				  NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7254 }
7255 
7256 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
7257 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7258 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7259 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7260 {
7261 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7262 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7263 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7264 }
7265 
7266 /**
7267  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7268  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7269  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7270  *
7271  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7272  */
7273 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7274 
7275 /**
7276  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7277  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7278  * @bss: the BSS struct
7279  *
7280  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7281  */
7282 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7283 
7284 /**
7285  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7286  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7287  * @bss: the bss to remove
7288  *
7289  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7290  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7291  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7292  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7293  */
7294 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7295 
7296 /**
7297  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7298  *
7299  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7300  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7301  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7302  *
7303  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7304  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7305  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7306  * @iter: the iterator function to call
7307  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7308  */
7309 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7310 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7311 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7312 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7313 				    void *data),
7314 		       void *iter_data);
7315 
7316 /**
7317  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7318  * @dev: network device
7319  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7320  * @len: length of the frame data
7321  *
7322  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7323  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7324  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7325  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7326  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7327  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7328  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7329  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7330  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7331  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7332  *
7333  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7334  */
7335 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7336 
7337 /**
7338  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7339  * @dev: network device
7340  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7341  *
7342  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7343  * mutex.
7344  */
7345 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7346 
7347 /**
7348  * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7349  * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
7350  *	moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7351  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7352  * @len: length of the frame data
7353  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7354  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7355  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7356  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7357  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7358  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7359  *	non-MLO connections
7360  * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7361  *	were rejected by the AP.
7362  */
7363 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7364 	const u8 *buf;
7365 	size_t len;
7366 	const u8 *req_ies;
7367 	size_t req_ies_len;
7368 	int uapsd_queues;
7369 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7370 	struct {
7371 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7372 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7373 		u16 status;
7374 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7375 };
7376 
7377 /**
7378  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7379  * @dev: network device
7380  * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7381  *
7382  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7383  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7384  *
7385  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7386  */
7387 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7388 			    const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7389 
7390 /**
7391  * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7392  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7393  * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7394  *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7395  * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7396  *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7397  *	other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7398  */
7399 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7400 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7401 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7402 	bool timeout;
7403 };
7404 
7405 /**
7406  * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7407  * @dev: network device
7408  * @data: data describing the association failure
7409  *
7410  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7411  */
7412 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7413 			    struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7414 
7415 /**
7416  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7417  * @dev: network device
7418  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7419  * @len: length of the frame data
7420  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7421  *
7422  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7423  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7424  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7425  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7426  */
7427 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7428 			   bool reconnect);
7429 
7430 /**
7431  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7432  * @dev: network device
7433  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7434  * @len: length of the frame data
7435  *
7436  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7437  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7438  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7439  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7440  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7441  *
7442  * This function may sleep.
7443  */
7444 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7445 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7446 
7447 /**
7448  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7449  * @dev: network device
7450  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7451  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7452  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7453  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7454  * @gfp: allocation flags
7455  *
7456  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7457  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7458  * primitive.
7459  */
7460 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7461 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7462 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7463 
7464 /**
7465  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7466  *
7467  * @dev: network device
7468  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7469  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7470  * @gfp: allocation flags
7471  *
7472  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7473  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7474  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7475  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7476  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7477  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7478  */
7479 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7480 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7481 
7482 /**
7483  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7484  * 					candidate
7485  *
7486  * @dev: network device
7487  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7488  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7489  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7490  * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7491  * @gfp: allocation flags
7492  *
7493  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7494  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7495  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7496  */
7497 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7498 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7499 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7500 
7501 /**
7502  * DOC: RFkill integration
7503  *
7504  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7505  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7506  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7507  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7508  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7509  *
7510  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7511  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7512  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7513  */
7514 
7515 /**
7516  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7517  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7518  * @blocked: block status
7519  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7520  */
7521 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7522 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7523 
7524 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7525 {
7526 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7527 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7528 }
7529 
7530 /**
7531  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7532  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7533  */
7534 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7535 
7536 /**
7537  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7538  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7539  */
7540 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7541 {
7542 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7543 }
7544 
7545 /**
7546  * DOC: Vendor commands
7547  *
7548  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7549  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7550  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7551  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7552  * the configuration mechanism.
7553  *
7554  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7555  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7556  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7557  *
7558  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7559  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7560  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7561  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7562  * managers etc. need.
7563  */
7564 
7565 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7566 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7567 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7568 					   int approxlen);
7569 
7570 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7571 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7572 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7573 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7574 					   unsigned int portid,
7575 					   int vendor_event_idx,
7576 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7577 
7578 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7579 
7580 /**
7581  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7582  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7583  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7584  *	be put into the skb
7585  *
7586  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7587  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7588  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7589  *
7590  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7591  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7592  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7593  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7594  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7595  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7596  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7597  *
7598  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7599  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7600  *
7601  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7602  */
7603 static inline struct sk_buff *
7604 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7605 {
7606 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7607 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7608 }
7609 
7610 /**
7611  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7612  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7613  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7614  *
7615  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7616  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7617  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
7618  * skb regardless of the return value.
7619  *
7620  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7621  */
7622 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7623 
7624 /**
7625  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7626  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7627  *
7628  * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7629  * Valid to call only there.
7630  */
7631 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7632 
7633 /**
7634  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7635  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7636  * @wdev: the wireless device
7637  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7638  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7639  *	be put into the skb
7640  * @gfp: allocation flags
7641  *
7642  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7643  * vendor-specific multicast group.
7644  *
7645  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7646  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7647  * attribute.
7648  *
7649  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7650  * skb to send the event.
7651  *
7652  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7653  */
7654 static inline struct sk_buff *
7655 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7656 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7657 {
7658 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7659 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7660 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7661 }
7662 
7663 /**
7664  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7665  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7666  * @wdev: the wireless device
7667  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7668  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7669  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7670  *	be put into the skb
7671  * @gfp: allocation flags
7672  *
7673  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7674  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7675  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7676  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7677  *
7678  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7679  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7680  * attribute.
7681  *
7682  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7683  * skb to send the event.
7684  *
7685  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7686  */
7687 static inline struct sk_buff *
7688 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7689 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7690 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7691 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7692 {
7693 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7694 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7695 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7696 }
7697 
7698 /**
7699  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7700  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7701  * @gfp: allocation flags
7702  *
7703  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7704  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7705  */
7706 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7707 {
7708 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7709 }
7710 
7711 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7712 /**
7713  * DOC: Test mode
7714  *
7715  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7716  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7717  * factory programming.
7718  *
7719  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
7720  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
7721  */
7722 
7723 /**
7724  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
7725  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7726  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7727  *	be put into the skb
7728  *
7729  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7730  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7731  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
7732  *
7733  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
7734  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7735  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7736  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7737  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7738  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
7739  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
7740  *
7741  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
7742  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
7743  *
7744  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7745  */
7746 static inline struct sk_buff *
7747 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7748 {
7749 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7750 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
7751 }
7752 
7753 /**
7754  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
7755  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7756  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
7757  *
7758  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7759  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
7760  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
7761  * regardless of the return value.
7762  *
7763  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7764  */
7765 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
7766 {
7767 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
7768 }
7769 
7770 /**
7771  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
7772  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7773  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7774  *	be put into the skb
7775  * @gfp: allocation flags
7776  *
7777  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7778  * testmode multicast group.
7779  *
7780  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
7781  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
7782  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
7783  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
7784  * in any other way.
7785  *
7786  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
7787  * skb to send the event.
7788  *
7789  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7790  */
7791 static inline struct sk_buff *
7792 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
7793 {
7794 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7795 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
7796 					  approxlen, gfp);
7797 }
7798 
7799 /**
7800  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
7801  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7802  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
7803  * @gfp: allocation flags
7804  *
7805  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7806  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
7807  * consumes it.
7808  */
7809 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7810 {
7811 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7812 }
7813 
7814 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
7815 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
7816 #else
7817 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
7818 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
7819 #endif
7820 
7821 /**
7822  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
7823  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
7824  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
7825  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
7826  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
7827  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
7828  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
7829  *	status for a FILS connection.
7830  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7831  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
7832  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
7833  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7834  */
7835 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
7836 	const u8 *kek;
7837 	size_t kek_len;
7838 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
7839 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
7840 	const u8 *pmk;
7841 	size_t pmk_len;
7842 	const u8 *pmkid;
7843 };
7844 
7845 /**
7846  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
7847  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7848  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7849  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7850  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7851  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7852  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7853  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7854  *	case.
7855  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
7856  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7857  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7858  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7859  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7860  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7861  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7862  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7863  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7864  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7865  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7866  * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
7867  *	zero.
7868  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7869  * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
7870  *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
7871  *	connected AP info.
7872  * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
7873  *	%NULL.
7874  * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
7875  *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
7876  * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
7877  *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
7878  *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
7879  *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
7880  *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
7881  *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
7882  *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
7883  *	to be specified.
7884  * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
7885  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
7886  *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
7887  */
7888 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7889 	int status;
7890 	const u8 *req_ie;
7891 	size_t req_ie_len;
7892 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7893 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7894 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7895 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
7896 
7897 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7898 	u16 valid_links;
7899 	struct {
7900 		const u8 *addr;
7901 		const u8 *bssid;
7902 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7903 		u16 status;
7904 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7905 };
7906 
7907 /**
7908  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7909  *
7910  * @dev: network device
7911  * @params: connection response parameters
7912  * @gfp: allocation flags
7913  *
7914  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7915  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7916  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
7917  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
7918  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
7919  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7920  */
7921 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
7922 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
7923 			   gfp_t gfp);
7924 
7925 /**
7926  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7927  *
7928  * @dev: network device
7929  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7930  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7931  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7932  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7933  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7934  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7935  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7936  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7937  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7938  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7939  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7940  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7941  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7942  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7943  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7944  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7945  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7946  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7947  *	case.
7948  * @gfp: allocation flags
7949  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7950  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7951  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7952  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7953  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7954  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7955  *
7956  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7957  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7958  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
7959  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
7960  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7961  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7962  */
7963 static inline void
7964 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7965 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
7966 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
7967 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
7968 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7969 {
7970 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
7971 
7972 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
7973 	params.status = status;
7974 	params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
7975 	params.links[0].bss = bss;
7976 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
7977 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
7978 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
7979 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
7980 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
7981 
7982 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
7983 }
7984 
7985 /**
7986  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7987  *
7988  * @dev: network device
7989  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7990  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7991  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7992  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7993  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7994  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7995  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7996  *	the real status code for failures.
7997  * @gfp: allocation flags
7998  *
7999  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8000  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8001  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8002  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8003  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8004  */
8005 static inline void
8006 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8007 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8008 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8009 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8010 {
8011 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8012 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8013 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8014 }
8015 
8016 /**
8017  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8018  *
8019  * @dev: network device
8020  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8021  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8022  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8023  * @gfp: allocation flags
8024  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8025  *
8026  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8027  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8028  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8029  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8030  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8031  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8032  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8033  */
8034 static inline void
8035 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8036 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8037 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8038 {
8039 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8040 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
8041 }
8042 
8043 /**
8044  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8045  *
8046  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8047  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8048  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8049  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8050  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8051  * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8052  *	Otherwise zero.
8053  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8054  * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8055  *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8056  * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8057  * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8058  *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8059  *	%NULL if %links.bss is set.
8060  * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8061  * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8062  *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8063  *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8064  */
8065 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
8066 	const u8 *req_ie;
8067 	size_t req_ie_len;
8068 	const u8 *resp_ie;
8069 	size_t resp_ie_len;
8070 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8071 
8072 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8073 	u16 valid_links;
8074 	struct {
8075 		const u8 *addr;
8076 		const u8 *bssid;
8077 		struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8078 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8079 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8080 };
8081 
8082 /**
8083  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8084  *
8085  * @dev: network device
8086  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8087  * @gfp: allocation flags
8088  *
8089  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8090  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8091  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8092  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8093  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8094  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8095  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8096  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8097  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8098  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8099  */
8100 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8101 		     gfp_t gfp);
8102 
8103 /**
8104  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8105  *
8106  * @dev: network device
8107  * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8108  *	in case of AP/P2P GO
8109  * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8110  * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8111  * @gfp: allocation flags
8112  *
8113  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8114  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8115  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8116  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8117  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8118  * indicate the 802.11 association.
8119  * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8120  * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8121  * associated STA/GC.
8122  */
8123 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8124 			      const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8125 
8126 /**
8127  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8128  *
8129  * @dev: network device
8130  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8131  * @ie_len: length of IEs
8132  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8133  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8134  * @gfp: allocation flags
8135  *
8136  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8137  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8138  */
8139 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8140 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8141 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8142 
8143 /**
8144  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8145  * @wdev: wireless device
8146  * @cookie: the request cookie
8147  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8148  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8149  *	channel
8150  * @gfp: allocation flags
8151  */
8152 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8153 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8154 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8155 
8156 /**
8157  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8158  * @wdev: wireless device
8159  * @cookie: the request cookie
8160  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8161  * @gfp: allocation flags
8162  */
8163 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8164 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8165 					gfp_t gfp);
8166 
8167 /**
8168  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8169  * @wdev: wireless device
8170  * @cookie: the requested cookie
8171  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8172  * @gfp: allocation flags
8173  */
8174 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8175 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8176 
8177 /**
8178  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8179  *
8180  * @sinfo: the station information
8181  * @gfp: allocation flags
8182  */
8183 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8184 
8185 /**
8186  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8187  * @sinfo: the station information
8188  *
8189  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8190  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8191  * the stack.)
8192  */
8193 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8194 {
8195 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8196 }
8197 
8198 /**
8199  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8200  *
8201  * @dev: the netdev
8202  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8203  * @sinfo: the station information
8204  * @gfp: allocation flags
8205  */
8206 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8207 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8208 
8209 /**
8210  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8211  * @dev: the netdev
8212  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8213  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8214  * @gfp: allocation flags
8215  */
8216 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8217 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8218 
8219 /**
8220  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8221  *
8222  * @dev: the netdev
8223  * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8224  * @gfp: allocation flags
8225  */
8226 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8227 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8228 {
8229 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8230 }
8231 
8232 /**
8233  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8234  *
8235  * @dev: the netdev
8236  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8237  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8238  * @gfp: allocation flags
8239  *
8240  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8241  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8242  * for some reasons, this function is called.
8243  *
8244  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8245  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8246  */
8247 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8248 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8249 			  gfp_t gfp);
8250 
8251 /**
8252  * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8253  *
8254  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8255  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8256  * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8257  *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8258  * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on
8259  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8260  * @len: length of the frame data
8261  * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8262  * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8263  * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8264  */
8265 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8266 	int freq;
8267 	int sig_dbm;
8268 	bool have_link_id;
8269 	u8 link_id;
8270 	const u8 *buf;
8271 	size_t len;
8272 	u32 flags;
8273 	u64 rx_tstamp;
8274 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8275 };
8276 
8277 /**
8278  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8279  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8280  * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8281  *
8282  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8283  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8284  *
8285  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8286  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8287  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8288  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8289  */
8290 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8291 			  struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8292 
8293 /**
8294  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8295  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8296  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8297  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8298  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8299  * @len: length of the frame data
8300  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8301  *
8302  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8303  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8304  *
8305  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8306  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8307  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8308  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8309  */
8310 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8311 					int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8312 					u32 flags)
8313 {
8314 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8315 		.freq = freq,
8316 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8317 		.buf = buf,
8318 		.len = len,
8319 		.flags = flags
8320 	};
8321 
8322 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8323 }
8324 
8325 /**
8326  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8327  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8328  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8329  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8330  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8331  * @len: length of the frame data
8332  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8333  *
8334  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8335  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8336  *
8337  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8338  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8339  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8340  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8341  */
8342 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8343 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8344 				    u32 flags)
8345 {
8346 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8347 		.freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8348 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8349 		.buf = buf,
8350 		.len = len,
8351 		.flags = flags
8352 	};
8353 
8354 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8355 }
8356 
8357 /**
8358  * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8359  *
8360  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8361  * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8362  * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8363  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8364  * @len: length of the frame data
8365  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8366  */
8367 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8368 	u64 cookie;
8369 	u64 tx_tstamp;
8370 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8371 	const u8 *buf;
8372 	size_t len;
8373 	bool ack;
8374 };
8375 
8376 /**
8377  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8378  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8379  * @status: TX status data
8380  * @gfp: context flags
8381  *
8382  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8383  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8384  * transmission attempt with extended info.
8385  */
8386 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8387 				 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8388 
8389 /**
8390  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8391  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8392  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8393  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8394  * @len: length of the frame data
8395  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8396  * @gfp: context flags
8397  *
8398  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8399  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8400  * transmission attempt.
8401  */
8402 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8403 					   u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8404 					   size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8405 {
8406 	struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8407 		.cookie = cookie,
8408 		.buf = buf,
8409 		.len = len,
8410 		.ack = ack
8411 	};
8412 
8413 	cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8414 }
8415 
8416 /**
8417  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8418  *                                   port frames
8419  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8420  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8421  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8422  * @len: length of the frame data
8423  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8424  * @gfp: context flags
8425  *
8426  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8427  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8428  * the transmission attempt.
8429  */
8430 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8431 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8432 				     gfp_t gfp);
8433 
8434 /**
8435  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8436  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8437  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
8438  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
8439  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8440  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
8441  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8442  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8443  * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8444  *
8445  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8446  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8447  * control port frames over nl80211.
8448  *
8449  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8450  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8451  *
8452  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8453  */
8454 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8455 			      bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8456 
8457 /**
8458  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8459  * @dev: network device
8460  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8461  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8462  * @gfp: context flags
8463  *
8464  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8465  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8466  */
8467 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8468 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8469 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8470 
8471 /**
8472  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8473  * @dev: network device
8474  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8475  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8476  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8477  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8478  * @gfp: context flags
8479  */
8480 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8481 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8482 
8483 /**
8484  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8485  * @dev: network device
8486  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8487  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8488  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8489  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8490  * @gfp: context flags
8491  *
8492  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8493  * given interval is exceeded.
8494  */
8495 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8496 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8497 
8498 /**
8499  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8500  * @dev: network device
8501  * @gfp: context flags
8502  *
8503  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8504  */
8505 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8506 
8507 /**
8508  * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8509  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8510  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8511  * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8512  * @gfp: context flags
8513  *
8514  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8515  */
8516 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8517 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8518 			    bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8519 
8520 static inline void
8521 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8522 		     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8523 		     gfp_t gfp)
8524 {
8525 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8526 }
8527 
8528 static inline void
8529 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8530 				struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8531 				gfp_t gfp)
8532 {
8533 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8534 }
8535 
8536 /**
8537  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8538  * @dev: network device
8539  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8540  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8541  * @gfp: context flags
8542  *
8543  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8544  * frame.
8545  */
8546 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8547 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8548 				       gfp_t gfp);
8549 
8550 /**
8551  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8552  * @netdev: network device
8553  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8554  * @event: type of event
8555  * @gfp: context flags
8556  *
8557  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8558  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8559  * also by full-MAC drivers.
8560  */
8561 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8562 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8563 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
8564 
8565 /**
8566  * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8567  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8568  *
8569  * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8570  * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8571  */
8572 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8573 
8574 /**
8575  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8576  * @dev: network device
8577  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8578  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8579  * @gfp: allocation flags
8580  */
8581 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8582 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8583 
8584 /**
8585  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8586  * @dev: network device
8587  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8588  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8589  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8590  * @gfp: allocation flags
8591  */
8592 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8593 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8594 
8595 /**
8596  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8597  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8598  * @addr: the transmitter address
8599  * @gfp: context flags
8600  *
8601  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8602  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8603  * sender.
8604  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8605  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8606  */
8607 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8608 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8609 
8610 /**
8611  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8612  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8613  * @addr: the transmitter address
8614  * @gfp: context flags
8615  *
8616  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8617  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8618  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8619  * station to avoid event flooding.
8620  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8621  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8622  */
8623 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8624 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8625 
8626 /**
8627  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8628  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8629  * @addr: the address of the peer
8630  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8631  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8632  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8633  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8634  * @gfp: allocation flags
8635  */
8636 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8637 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8638 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8639 
8640 /**
8641  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8642  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8643  * @frame: the frame
8644  * @len: length of the frame
8645  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8646  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8647  *
8648  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8649  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8650  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8651  */
8652 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8653 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8654 
8655 /**
8656  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8657  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8658  * @frame: the frame
8659  * @len: length of the frame
8660  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8661  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8662  *
8663  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8664  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8665  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8666  */
8667 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8668 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8669 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
8670 {
8671 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8672 					sig_dbm);
8673 }
8674 
8675 /**
8676  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8677  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8678  * @chandef: the channel definition
8679  * @iftype: interface type
8680  *
8681  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8682  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8683  */
8684 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8685 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8686 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8687 
8688 /**
8689  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
8690  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8691  * @chandef: the channel definition
8692  * @iftype: interface type
8693  *
8694  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8695  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
8696  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
8697  * more permissive conditions.
8698  *
8699  * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
8700  */
8701 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8702 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8703 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8704 
8705 /*
8706  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
8707  * @dev: the device which switched channels
8708  * @chandef: the new channel definition
8709  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8710  * @punct_bitmap: the new puncturing bitmap
8711  *
8712  * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
8713  * driver context!
8714  */
8715 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8716 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8717 			       unsigned int link_id, u16 punct_bitmap);
8718 
8719 /*
8720  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
8721  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
8722  * @chandef: the future channel definition
8723  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8724  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
8725  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
8726  * @punct_bitmap: the future puncturing bitmap
8727  *
8728  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
8729  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
8730  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
8731  */
8732 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8733 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8734 				       unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
8735 				       bool quiet, u16 punct_bitmap);
8736 
8737 /**
8738  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
8739  *
8740  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8741  * @band: band pointer to fill
8742  *
8743  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8744  */
8745 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
8746 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
8747 
8748 /**
8749  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
8750  *
8751  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8752  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
8753  *
8754  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8755  */
8756 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8757 					  u8 *op_class);
8758 
8759 /**
8760  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
8761  *
8762  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8763  *
8764  * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
8765  */
8766 static inline u32
8767 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
8768 {
8769 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
8770 }
8771 
8772 /*
8773  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
8774  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
8775  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
8776  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
8777  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
8778  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
8779  * @gfp: allocation flags
8780  *
8781  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
8782  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
8783  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
8784  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
8785  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
8786  */
8787 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8788 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
8789 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
8790 
8791 /*
8792  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
8793  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
8794  *
8795  * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
8796  */
8797 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
8798 
8799 /**
8800  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
8801  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
8802  *
8803  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
8804  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
8805  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
8806  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
8807  * is unbound from the driver.
8808  *
8809  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8810  */
8811 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
8812 
8813 /**
8814  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
8815  * @dev: the netdev to register
8816  *
8817  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8818  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
8819  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
8820  * instead as well.
8821  *
8822  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8823  */
8824 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
8825 
8826 /**
8827  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
8828  * @dev: the netdev to register
8829  *
8830  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8831  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
8832  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
8833  * usable instead as well.
8834  *
8835  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8836  */
8837 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
8838 {
8839 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
8840 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
8841 #endif
8842 }
8843 
8844 /**
8845  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
8846  * @ies: FT IEs
8847  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
8848  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
8849  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
8850  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
8851  */
8852 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
8853 	const u8 *ies;
8854 	size_t ies_len;
8855 	const u8 *target_ap;
8856 	const u8 *ric_ies;
8857 	size_t ric_ies_len;
8858 };
8859 
8860 /**
8861  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
8862  * @netdev: network device
8863  * @ft_event: IE information
8864  */
8865 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8866 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
8867 
8868 /**
8869  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
8870  * @ies: the input IE buffer
8871  * @len: the input length
8872  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
8873  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
8874  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
8875  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
8876  *
8877  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
8878  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
8879  *
8880  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
8881  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
8882  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
8883  */
8884 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
8885 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
8886 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
8887 
8888 /**
8889  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
8890  * @ies: the IE buffer
8891  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8892  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8893  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8894  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8895  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8896  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
8897  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
8898  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8899  *
8900  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8901  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8902  * split.
8903  *
8904  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8905  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8906  *
8907  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8908  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8909  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8910  *
8911  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8912  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8913  * of the buffer should be used.
8914  */
8915 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8916 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
8917 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
8918 			      size_t offset);
8919 
8920 /**
8921  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
8922  * @ies: the IE buffer
8923  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8924  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8925  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8926  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8927  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8928  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8929  *
8930  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8931  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8932  * split.
8933  *
8934  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8935  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8936  *
8937  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8938  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8939  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8940  *
8941  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8942  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8943  * of the buffer should be used.
8944  */
8945 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8946 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
8947 {
8948 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
8949 }
8950 
8951 /**
8952  * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
8953  * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
8954  * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
8955  * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
8956  *
8957  * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
8958  * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
8959  * accordingly.
8960  */
8961 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
8962 
8963 /**
8964  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
8965  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
8966  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
8967  * @gfp: allocation flags
8968  *
8969  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
8970  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
8971  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
8972  * else caused the wakeup.
8973  */
8974 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8975 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
8976 				   gfp_t gfp);
8977 
8978 /**
8979  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
8980  *
8981  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
8982  * @gfp: allocation flags
8983  *
8984  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
8985  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
8986  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
8987  */
8988 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
8989 
8990 /**
8991  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
8992  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8993  *
8994  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
8995  */
8996 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8997 
8998 /**
8999  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9000  *
9001  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9002  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9003  *
9004  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9005  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9006  * the interface combinations.
9007  */
9008 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9009 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
9010 
9011 /**
9012  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9013  *
9014  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9015  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9016  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9017  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9018  *
9019  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9020  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9021  * purposes.
9022  */
9023 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9024 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
9025 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9026 					    void *data),
9027 			       void *data);
9028 
9029 /*
9030  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9031  *
9032  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9033  * @wdev: wireless device
9034  * @gfp: context flags
9035  *
9036  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9037  * disconnected.
9038  *
9039  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9040  */
9041 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9042 			 gfp_t gfp);
9043 
9044 /**
9045  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9046  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9047  *
9048  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9049  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9050  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9051  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9052  *
9053  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9054  * the driver while the function is running.
9055  */
9056 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9057 
9058 /**
9059  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9060  *
9061  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9062  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9063  *
9064  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9065  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9066  */
9067 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9068 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9069 {
9070 	u8 *ft_byte;
9071 
9072 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9073 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9074 }
9075 
9076 /**
9077  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9078  *
9079  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9080  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9081  *
9082  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9083  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9084  */
9085 static inline bool
9086 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9087 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9088 {
9089 	u8 ft_byte;
9090 
9091 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9092 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9093 }
9094 
9095 /**
9096  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9097  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9098  *
9099  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9100  */
9101 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9102 
9103 /**
9104  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9105  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9106  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9107  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9108  *	 result.
9109  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9110  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9111  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9112  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9113  * @info_len: the length of the &info
9114  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9115  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9116  */
9117 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9118 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9119 	u8 inst_id;
9120 	u8 peer_inst_id;
9121 	const u8 *addr;
9122 	u8 info_len;
9123 	const u8 *info;
9124 	u64 cookie;
9125 };
9126 
9127 /**
9128  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9129  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9130  * @match: match notification parameters
9131  * @gfp: allocation flags
9132  *
9133  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9134  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9135  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9136  */
9137 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9138 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9139 
9140 /**
9141  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9142  *
9143  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9144  * @inst_id: the local instance id
9145  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9146  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9147  * @gfp: allocation flags
9148  *
9149  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9150  */
9151 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9152 				  u8 inst_id,
9153 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9154 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9155 
9156 /* ethtool helper */
9157 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9158 
9159 /**
9160  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9161  * @netdev: network device
9162  * @params: External authentication parameters
9163  * @gfp: allocation flags
9164  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9165  */
9166 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9167 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9168 				   gfp_t gfp);
9169 
9170 /**
9171  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9172  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9173  * @req: the original measurement request
9174  * @result: the result data
9175  * @gfp: allocation flags
9176  */
9177 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9178 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9179 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9180 			  gfp_t gfp);
9181 
9182 /**
9183  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9184  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9185  * @req: the original measurement request
9186  * @gfp: allocation flags
9187  *
9188  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9189  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9190  */
9191 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9192 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9193 			    gfp_t gfp);
9194 
9195 /**
9196  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9197  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9198  * @iftype: interface type
9199  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9200  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9201  *
9202  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9203  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9204  * check_swif is '1'.
9205  */
9206 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9207 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9208 
9209 
9210 /**
9211  * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9212  * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9213  * @netdev: network device
9214  * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9215  * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9216  *
9217  * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9218  */
9219 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9220 			     const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9221 
9222 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9223 
9224 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9225 
9226 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
9227 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9228 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9229 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9230 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9231 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9232 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9233 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9234 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9235 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9236 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9237 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9238 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9239 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9240 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9241 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9242 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9243 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9244 
9245 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9246 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9247 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9248 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9249 
9250 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9251 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9252 
9253 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9254 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9255 
9256 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9257 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
9258 #else
9259 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
9260 ({									\
9261 	if (0)								\
9262 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
9263 	0;								\
9264 })
9265 #endif
9266 
9267 /*
9268  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9269  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9270  * file/line information and a backtrace.
9271  */
9272 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9273 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9274 
9275 /**
9276  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9277  * @netdev: network device
9278  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9279  * @gfp: allocation flags
9280  */
9281 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9282 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9283 				    gfp_t gfp);
9284 
9285 /**
9286  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9287  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9288  */
9289 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9290 
9291 /**
9292  * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9293  * @dev: network device
9294  * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9295  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9296  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9297  */
9298 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9299 			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9300 			      u64 color_bitmap);
9301 
9302 /**
9303  * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9304  * @dev: network device
9305  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9306  */
9307 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9308 						       u64 color_bitmap)
9309 {
9310 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9311 					 0, color_bitmap);
9312 }
9313 
9314 /**
9315  * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9316  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9317  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9318  *
9319  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9320  */
9321 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9322 						       u8 count)
9323 {
9324 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9325 					 count, 0);
9326 }
9327 
9328 /**
9329  * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9330  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9331  *
9332  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9333  */
9334 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9335 {
9336 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9337 					 0, 0);
9338 }
9339 
9340 /**
9341  * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9342  * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9343  *
9344  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9345  */
9346 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9347 {
9348 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9349 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9350 					 0, 0);
9351 }
9352 
9353 /**
9354  * cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap - validate puncturing bitmap
9355  * @bitmap: bitmap to be validated
9356  * @chandef: channel definition
9357  *
9358  * Validate the puncturing bitmap.
9359  *
9360  * Return: %true if the bitmap is valid. %false otherwise.
9361  */
9362 bool cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap(u16 *bitmap,
9363 					      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9364 
9365 /**
9366  * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9367  * @dev: network device.
9368  * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9369  *
9370  * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9371  * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9372  * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9373  * case disconnect instead.
9374  * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9375  */
9376 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9377 
9378 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9379 /**
9380  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9381  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9382  * @file: the file being read
9383  * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9384  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9385  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9386  * @count: read count
9387  * @ppos: read position
9388  * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9389  * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9390  */
9391 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9392 				  char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9393 				  char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9394 				  loff_t *ppos,
9395 				  ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9396 						     struct file *file,
9397 						     char *buf,
9398 						     size_t bufsize,
9399 						     void *data),
9400 				  void *data);
9401 
9402 /**
9403  * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9404  * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9405  * @file: the file being written to
9406  * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9407  * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9408  * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9409  * @count: read count
9410  * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9411  * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9412  */
9413 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9414 				   char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9415 				   const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9416 				   ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9417 						      struct file *file,
9418 						      char *buf,
9419 						      size_t count,
9420 						      void *data),
9421 				   void *data);
9422 #endif
9423 
9424 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9425